Revision: miles@gnu.org--gnu-2005/emacs--unicode--0--patch-63
[bpt/emacs.git] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 Fixme: The notes about Emacs 23 are quite incomplete.
18
19 \f
20 * Changes in Emacs 23.1
21
22 ** The Emacs character set is now a superset of Unicode.
23 (It has about four times the code space, which should be plenty).
24
25 The internal encoding used for buffers and strings is now
26 Unicode-based and called `utf-8-emacs'. utf-8-emacs is backwards
27 compatible with the UTF-8 encoding of Unicode. The `emacs-mule'
28 coding system can still read and write data in the old internal
29 encoding.
30
31 There are still charsets which contain disjoint sets of characters
32 where this is necessary or useful, especially for various Far Eastern
33 sets which are problematic with Unicode.
34
35 Since the internal encoding is also used by default for byte-compiled
36 files -- i.e. the normal coding system for byte-compiled Lisp files is
37 now utf-8-Emacs -- Lisp containing non-ASCII characters which is
38 compiled by Emacs 23 can't be read by earlier versions of Emacs. Files
39 compiled by Emacs 20, 21, or 22 are loaded correctly as emacs-mule
40 (whether or not they contain multibyte characters), which makes loading
41 them somewhat slower than Emacs 23-compiled files. Thus it may be worth
42 recompiling existing .elc files which don't need to be shared with older
43 Emacsen.
44
45 ** There are assorted new coding systems/aliases -- see
46 M-x list-coding-systems.
47
48 ** New charset implementation with many new charsets.
49 See M-x list-character-sets. New charsets can be defined conveniently
50 as tables of unicodes.
51
52 The dimension of a charset is now 0, 1, 2, or 3, and the size of each
53 dimension is no longer limited to 94 or 96.
54
55 Generic characters no longer exist.
56
57 A dynamic charset priority list is used to infer the charset of
58 unicodes for display &c.
59
60 ** The following facilities are obsolete:
61
62 Minor modes: unify-8859-on-encoding-mode, unify-8859-on-decoding-mode
63
64 \f
65 * Lisp changes in Emacs 23.1
66
67 map-char-table's behaviour has changed.
68
69 New functions: characterp, max-char, map-charset-chars,
70 define-charset-alias, primary-charset, set-primary-charset,
71 unify-charset, clear-charset-maps, charset-priority-list,
72 set-charset-priority, define-coding-system,
73 define-coding-system-alias, coding-system-aliases, langinfo,
74 string-to-multibyte.
75
76 Changed functions: copy-sequence, decode-char, encode-char,
77 set-fontset-font, new-fontset, modify-syntax-entry, define-charset,
78 modify-category-entry
79
80 Obsoleted: char-bytes, chars-in-region, set-coding-priority,
81 char-valid-p
82
83 \f
84 * Incompatible Lisp changes
85
86 Deleted functions: make-coding-system, register-char-codings,
87 coding-system-spec
88
89 ** The character codes for characters from the
90 eight-bit-control/eight-bit-graphic charsets aren't now in the range
91 128-255.
92 \f
93 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
94
95 ---
96 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
97 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
98 installed programs.
99
100 ---
101 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
102
103 ---
104 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
105 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
106 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
107
108 ---
109 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with Lisp code.
110
111 ---
112 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
113 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
114 place for game scores to be stored. You can control this with the
115 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
116 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
117 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
118 in each user's home directory.
119
120 ---
121 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
122 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
123 Emacs with Leim.
124
125 +++
126 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
127
128 The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual in Info format is built as part of the
129 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
130 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
131 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
132
133 ---
134 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
135 the distribution.
136
137 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
138 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
139 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
140 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
141
142 ---
143 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the
144 following languages: Brasilian Portuguese, Bulgarian, Chinese (both
145 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
146 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
147 doesn't automatically select the right one.
148
149 ---
150 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
151
152 ---
153 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
154 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
155 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
156 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
157
158 ---
159 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
160
161 ---
162 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
163
164 ---
165 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
166
167 ---
168 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
169 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
170
171 ---
172 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
173
174 ---
175 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
176 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
177 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
178
179 ---
180 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
181 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
182
183 ---
184 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
185 much pure storage it will approximately need.
186
187 ** The script etc/emacs-buffer.gdb can be used with gdb to retrieve the
188 contents of buffers from a core dump and save them to files easily, should
189 emacs crash.
190
191 \f
192 * Startup Changes in Emacs 22.1
193
194 +++
195 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
196 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
197 the fancy startup screen.
198
199 +++
200 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
201 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
202 the blinking cursor.
203
204 +++
205 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
206 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
207
208 +++
209 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
210 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
211 can start with this line:
212
213 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
214
215 +++
216 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
217 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
218 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
219
220 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
221
222 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
223 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
224
225 +++
226 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
227 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
228
229 +++
230 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
231 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
232 an interactively callable function.
233
234 +++
235 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
236 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
237 affects the initial frame.
238
239 +++
240 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
241 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
242 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
243 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
244 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
245
246 +++
247 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
248 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
249 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
250 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
251 `inhibit-splash-screen').
252
253 +++
254 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
255 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
256 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
257
258 +++
259 ** Init file changes
260 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
261 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
262
263 +++
264 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
265 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
266 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
267 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
268 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
269 \f
270 * Incompatible Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
271
272 +++
273 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
274 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
275 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
276 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
277
278 +++
279 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
280 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
281
282 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
283 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
284
285 +++
286 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
287 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
288 the operating system or your X server.
289
290 +++
291 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
292
293 +++
294 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
295 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
296 you about it.
297
298 +++
299 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
300 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
301
302 +++
303 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
304 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
305 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
306
307 +++
308 ** The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
309 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
310
311 +++
312 ** In incremental search, C-w is changed. M-%, C-M-w and C-M-y are special.
313
314 See below under "incremental search changes".
315
316 ---
317 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
318
319 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
320 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
321 directory with Dired.
322
323 +++
324 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
325 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
326 it remains unchanged.
327
328 +++
329 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
330 M-o M-o requests refontification.
331
332 +++
333 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
334
335 See below for more details.
336
337 +++
338 ** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
339 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
340 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
341 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
342 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
343 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
344 \f
345 * Editing Changes in Emacs 22.1
346
347 +++
348 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
349 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
350
351 +++
352 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
353 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
354 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
355 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
356
357 +++
358 ** C-u M-g M-g switches to the most recent previous buffer,
359 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
360
361 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
362 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
363
364 +++
365 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
366 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
367 the operating system or your X server.
368
369 +++
370 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
371
372 +++
373 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
374 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
375 you about it.
376
377 +++
378 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
379 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
380
381 +++
382 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
383 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
384 can be used as well.
385
386 +++
387 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
388
389 +++
390 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
391 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
392
393 ---
394 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
395 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
396
397 ---
398 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
399 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
400
401 +++
402 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
403 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
404 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
405 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
406
407 +++
408 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
409 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
410 in Indented-Text mode.
411
412 +++
413 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variable references.
414
415 Substrings of the form `$foo' and `${foo}' in the specified new value
416 now refer to the value of environment variable foo. To include a `$'
417 in the value, use `$$'.
418
419 +++
420 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
421 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
422 `same-window'.
423
424 +++
425 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
426 from the locale.
427
428 ** The command `list-faces-display' now accepts a prefix arg.
429 When passed, the function prompts for a regular expression and lists
430 only faces matching this regexp.
431
432 ** Mark command changes:
433
434 +++
435 *** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
436 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
437 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
438
439 +++
440 *** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times.
441
442 If you type C-M-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h
443 (mark-paragraph), or C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region
444 extends each time, so you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC
445 M-C-SPC, for example. This feature also works for
446 mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to a key. It also extends the
447 region when the mark is active in Transient Mark mode, regardless of
448 the last command. To start a new region with one of marking commands
449 in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the active region with C-g,
450 or set the new mark with C-SPC.
451
452 +++
453 *** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
454
455 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
456 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
457 paragraphs.
458
459 +++
460 *** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
461 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
462 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
463 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
464 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
465 command only.
466
467 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
468 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
469 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
470 mark or the region.
471
472 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
473 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
474 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
475 C-g.
476
477 +++
478 *** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
479 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
480 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
481
482 ** Help command changes:
483
484 +++
485 *** Changes in C-h bindings:
486
487 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
488
489 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
490 that do not change:
491
492 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
493 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
494
495 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
496 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
497
498 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
499
500 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
501 run by the key sequence.
502
503 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
504 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
505 that command.
506
507 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
508 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
509
510 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
511 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
512
513 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
514 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
515
516 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
517 new-kill-line is on C-k
518
519 ---
520 *** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
521 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
522 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
523 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
524
525 +++
526 *** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
527 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
528
529 +++
530 *** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
531 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
532 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
533 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
534 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
535 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
536 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
537
538 +++
539 *** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
540 description various information about a character, including its
541 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
542 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
543 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
544
545 +++
546 *** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
547 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
548
549 +++
550 *** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
551 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
552 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
553 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
554 keyboard oriented alternative.
555
556 +++
557 *** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
558 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
559 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
560 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
561 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
562
563 +++
564 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
565 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
566 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
567 available.
568
569 +++
570 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
571 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
572 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
573 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
574 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
575 matching item.
576
577 ** Incremental Search changes:
578
579 +++
580 *** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
581 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
582 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
583 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
584 for details.
585
586 +++
587 *** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
588 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
589 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
590 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
591
592 +++
593 *** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
594 at the end of a line.
595
596 +++
597 *** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
598 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
599 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
600
601 +++
602 *** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
603 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
604 search string used as the string to replace.
605
606 +++
607 *** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
608 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
609 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
610
611 ** Replace command changes:
612
613 ---
614 *** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
615 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
616 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
617
618 +++
619 *** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
620 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
621 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
622 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
623 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
624 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
625 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
626 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
627 can be edited for each replacement.
628
629 +++
630 *** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
631 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
632
633 ---
634 *** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
635 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
636
637 ** File operation changes:
638
639 +++
640 *** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
641 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
642 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
643 is only rarely needed.
644
645 +++
646 *** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
647 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
648
649 +++
650 *** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
651 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
652
653 +++
654 *** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
655 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
656
657 +++
658 *** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
659
660 ---
661 *** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
662
663 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
664 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
665 directory with Dired.
666
667 +++
668 *** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
669 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
670 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
671 file.)
672
673 +++
674 *** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
675 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
676
677 +++
678 *** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
679 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
680 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
681 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
682 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
683 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
684
685 ---
686 *** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
687 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
688 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
689
690 ---
691 *** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
692 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
693 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
694
695 +++
696 *** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
697 Emacs asks for confirmation.
698
699 +++
700 *** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
701
702 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
703 when visiting the file.
704
705 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
706 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
707 when saving the file.
708
709 +++
710 *** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
711 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
712 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
713 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
714 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
715 modes do.
716
717 ** Minibuffer changes:
718
719 +++
720 *** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
721 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
722 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
723 prompt string.
724
725 ---
726 *** Enhanced visual feedback in `*Completions*' buffer.
727
728 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
729 have in common and where they begin to differ.
730
731 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
732 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
733 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
734 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
735 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
736 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
737 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
738 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
739
740 +++
741 *** File-name completion can now ignore specified directories.
742 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
743 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
744 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
745 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
746 candidate is a directory.
747
748 +++
749 *** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
750 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
751 it remains unchanged.
752
753 +++
754 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
755 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
756 elements are deleted.
757
758 ** Redisplay changes:
759
760 +++
761 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
762 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
763 appears between the position information and the major mode.
764
765 +++
766 *** New face `escape-glyph' highlights control characters and escape glyphs.
767
768 +++
769 *** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
770 character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
771 to nil.
772
773 +++
774 *** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
775 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
776 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
777 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
778
779 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
780 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
781 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
782 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
783 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
784 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
785
786 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
787 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
788
789 ---
790 *** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
791 the window now works sensibly, by automatically adjusting the window's
792 vscroll property.
793
794 +++
795 *** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
796 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
797 the mode line of the currently selected window.
798
799 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
800 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
801
802 +++
803 *** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
804 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
805 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
806 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
807 set-fringe-style.
808
809 +++
810 *** Angle icons in the fringes can indicate the buffer boundaries. In
811 addition, up and down arrow bitmaps in the fringe indicate which ways
812 the window can be scrolled.
813
814 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
815 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
816 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
817
818 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
819 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
820
821 The value can also be an alist which specifies the presence and
822 position of each bitmap individually.
823
824 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
825 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
826 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
827 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
828
829 +++
830 *** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
831 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
832 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
833 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
834 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
835
836 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' can be set to nil to
837 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
838
839 +++
840 *** When a window has display margin areas, the fringes are now
841 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
842 outside those margins.
843
844 +++
845 *** A window can now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
846 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
847
848 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
849 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
850 or when the frame is resized.
851
852 ** Cursor display changes:
853
854 +++
855 *** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
856 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
857
858 +++
859 *** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
860
861 +++
862 *** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
863 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
864 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
865 cursor does.
866
867 +++
868 *** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
869 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
870 appears in.
871
872 +++
873 *** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
874 of the recognized cursor types.
875
876 ** New faces:
877
878 +++
879 *** `mode-line-highlight' is the standard face indicating mouse sensitive
880 elements on mode-line (and header-line) like `highlight' face on text
881 areas.
882
883 +++
884 *** `shadow' face defines the appearance of the "shadowed" text, i.e.
885 the text which should be less noticeable than the surrounding text.
886 This can be achieved by using shades of grey in contrast with either
887 black or white default foreground color. This generic shadow face
888 allows customization of the appearance of shadowed text in one place,
889 so package-specific faces can inherit from it.
890
891 ** Font-Lock changes:
892
893 +++
894 *** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
895 M-o M-o requests refontification.
896
897 +++
898 *** All modes now support using M-x font-lock-mode to toggle
899 fontification, even those such as Occur, Info, and comint-derived
900 modes that do their own fontification in a special way.
901
902 The variable `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable
903 fontification in Info, remove `turn-on-font-lock' from
904 `Info-mode-hook'.
905
906 +++
907 *** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
908 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
909 The default value is 1.
910
911 +++
912 *** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
913 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
914 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
915 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
916 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
917
918 +++
919 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
920
921 +++
922 *** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-comment-delimiter-face'.
923
924 +++
925 *** Easy to overlook single character negation can now be font-locked.
926 You can use the new variable `font-lock-negation-char-face' and the face of
927 the same name to customize this. Currently the cc-modes, sh-script-mode,
928 cperl-mode and make-mode support this.
929
930 ---
931 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
932 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
933 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
934 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
935 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
936
937 ---
938 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
939
940 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
941 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
942 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
943 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
944
945 ---
946 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
947
948 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
949 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
950 refontification takes place.
951
952 ** Menu support:
953
954 ---
955 *** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
956 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
957 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
958 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
959 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
960 current date and time, current line and column number in the
961 mode-line.
962
963 ---
964 *** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
965
966 ---
967 *** You can exit dialog windows and menus by typing C-g.
968
969 ---
970 *** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
971 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
972 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
973
974 +++
975 *** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
976 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
977
978 ---
979 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
980 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
981
982 +++
983 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
984 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
985 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
986
987 ---
988 *** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
989 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
990
991 +++
992 *** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
993 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
994 the new dialog.
995
996 ** Mouse changes:
997
998 +++
999 *** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
1000 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
1001 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
1002 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
1003 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
1004 feature is not enabled.
1005
1006 +++
1007 *** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
1008 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
1009 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
1010 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
1011 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
1012 to give it focus.
1013
1014 +++
1015 *** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
1016
1017 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
1018 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
1019 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
1020 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
1021 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior. (If you prefer the old
1022 behavior, set the user option `mouse-1-click-follows-link' to nil.)
1023
1024 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs can do much
1025 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
1026 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
1027 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
1028 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
1029 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
1030 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
1031 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
1032 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
1033
1034 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
1035 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
1036 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
1037 you release it).
1038
1039 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
1040 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
1041
1042 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
1043 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
1044
1045 +++
1046 *** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1047 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1048 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1049 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1050 also disable mouse highlighting.
1051
1052 +++
1053 *** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1054 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1055 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1056
1057 ---
1058 *** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1059 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1060
1061 ---
1062 *** Emacs ignores mouse-2 clicks while the mouse wheel is being moved.
1063
1064 People tend to push the mouse wheel (which counts as a mouse-2 click)
1065 unintentionally while turning the wheel, so these clicks are now
1066 ignored. You can customize this with the mouse-wheel-click-event and
1067 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1068
1069 +++
1070 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1071
1072 ** Mule changes:
1073
1074 ---
1075 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1076 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1077 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1078 This change can result in using the different coding systems as
1079 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
1080
1081 +++
1082 *** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1083 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1084 can mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1085 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1086 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1087 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1088 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1089 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
1090
1091 +++
1092 *** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1093 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1094
1095 +++
1096 *** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
1097 coding system.
1098
1099 +++
1100 *** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1101 of a file.
1102
1103 ---
1104 *** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
1105 unicode.
1106
1107 +++
1108 *** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1109 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1110 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1111 command.
1112
1113 +++
1114 *** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
1115 in the current input method to input a character at point.
1116
1117 +++
1118 *** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1119 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1120 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1121 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1122 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1123 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1124 mule-unicode-... ones.
1125
1126 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
1127 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1128 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1129 possible.
1130
1131 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1132 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1133 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
1134 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1135 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
1136
1137 ---
1138 *** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1139 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1140 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
1141 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
1142
1143 ---
1144 *** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
1145 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
1146 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1147 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1148 automatically according to the locale.)
1149
1150 ---
1151 *** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1152 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1153 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1154 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
1155 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1156 tamil-inscript.
1157
1158 ---
1159 *** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
1160 characters.
1161
1162 ---
1163 *** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
1164 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
1165 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
1166 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
1167 M-f (forward-word)
1168 M-b (backward-word)
1169 M-d (kill-word)
1170 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
1171 M-t (transpose-words)
1172 M-q (fill-paragraph)
1173
1174 ---
1175 *** Indian support has been updated.
1176 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1177 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
1178 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1179 supported.
1180
1181 ---
1182 *** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
1183
1184 ---
1185 *** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
1186 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1187 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1188 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1189 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1190 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1191 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
1192 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1193 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1194 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
1195 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
1196 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
1197
1198 ---
1199 *** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1200 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1201 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1202
1203 ---
1204 *** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1205 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
1206 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1207 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1208 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1209 latter is used by GNU locales.
1210
1211 ---
1212 *** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1213 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1214
1215 ---
1216 *** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1217 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1218 fontset appropriately.
1219
1220 ** Customize changes:
1221
1222 +++
1223 *** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
1224 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1225 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1226 faces.
1227
1228 ---
1229 *** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1230 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1231 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1232 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1233 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1234 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1235 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1236
1237 +++
1238 *** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1239 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1240 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1241 under the "[State]" button.
1242
1243 ** Buffer Menu changes:
1244
1245 +++
1246 *** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
1247 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
1248 mode.
1249
1250 +++
1251 *** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1252 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
1253 whose names begin with space are omitted.
1254
1255 ---
1256 *** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1257 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1258 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1259
1260 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1261 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
1262 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
1263 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1264 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1265
1266 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1267 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1268 t, and the status is shown.
1269
1270 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1271 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1272
1273 ** Dired mode:
1274
1275 ---
1276 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
1277 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
1278 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
1279
1280 +++
1281 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
1282 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
1283
1284 +++
1285 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1286 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1287
1288 +++
1289 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1290 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1291 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1292 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1293 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1294 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1295
1296 +++
1297 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1298 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1299
1300 +++
1301 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1302
1303 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
1304 dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O, marks omitted files. The variable
1305 dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the mode toggling function
1306 instead.
1307
1308 +++
1309 *** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1310 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1311 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1312 directory listing into a buffer.
1313
1314 ** Comint changes:
1315
1316 ---
1317 *** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1318 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1319 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1320 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1321 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1322
1323 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1324 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1325
1326 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1327 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1328 lines, including any prompts.
1329
1330 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1331 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1332 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1333 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1334 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1335 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1336 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1337
1338 +++
1339 *** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1340 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1341 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1342 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1343
1344 +++
1345 *** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1346 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1347 but declared obsolete.
1348
1349 ** M-x Compile changes:
1350
1351 ---
1352 *** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1353
1354 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1355 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1356 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1357 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1358
1359 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1360 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1361 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1362
1363 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1364 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1365 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1366 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1367 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1368
1369 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1370
1371 +++
1372 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1373 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1374 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1375 subprocesses inherit.
1376
1377 +++
1378 *** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1379 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1380 in new face `next-error'.
1381
1382 +++
1383 *** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1384 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1385 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1386 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1387 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1388 C-c C-f.
1389
1390 +++
1391 *** When the left fringe is displayed, an arrow points to current message in
1392 the compilation buffer.
1393
1394 +++
1395 *** The new variable `compilation-context-lines' controls lines of leading
1396 context before the current message. If nil and the left fringe is displayed,
1397 it doesn't scroll the compilation output window. If there is no left fringe,
1398 no arrow is displayed and a value of nil means display the message at the top
1399 of the window.
1400
1401 ** Occur mode changes:
1402
1403 +++
1404 *** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1405 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1406 switching to it.
1407
1408 +++
1409 *** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1410 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1411
1412 +++
1413 *** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1414 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1415 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1416 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1417 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1418
1419 ** Grep changes:
1420
1421 +++
1422 *** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1423
1424 There's a new separate package grep.el, with its own submenu and
1425 customization group.
1426
1427 ---
1428 *** M-x grep provides highlighting support.
1429
1430 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1431 can be saved and automatically revisited.
1432
1433 +++
1434 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1435 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1436
1437 ---
1438 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1439 `grep-scroll-output' override the corresponding compilation mode
1440 settings, for grep commands only.
1441
1442 +++
1443 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1444 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1445 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1446 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1447 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1448 source line is highlighted.
1449
1450 +++
1451 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1452 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1453 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1454 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1455 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1456 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1457 file.
1458
1459 +++
1460 *** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1461 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1462 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1463 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1464 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1465 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1466
1467 ** X Windows Support:
1468
1469 +++
1470 *** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
1471 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
1472 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
1473
1474 +++
1475 *** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
1476 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
1477 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
1478 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
1479 Meta and Alt:
1480 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
1481 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
1482
1483 +++
1484 *** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which can
1485 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
1486
1487 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
1488 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
1489
1490 ---
1491 *** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1492 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1493 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1494 and use the more appropriately result.
1495
1496 ---
1497 *** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
1498 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1499 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1500
1501 ** Xterm support:
1502
1503 ---
1504 *** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
1505 display margin, when run in an xterm.
1506
1507 ---
1508 *** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
1509 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
1510 following should work:
1511 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
1512 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
1513 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
1514
1515 ** Character terminal color support changes:
1516
1517 +++
1518 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
1519 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1520 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1521 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1522 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1523 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1524 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1525 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1526 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1527
1528 ---
1529 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1530 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1531 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1532 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1533 all of these colors.
1534
1535 +++
1536 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1537 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1538 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
1539 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1540 colors as on X.
1541
1542 ---
1543 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1544 \f
1545 * New Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1
1546
1547 +++
1548 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1549 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1550 program files that include other program files.
1551
1552 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1553 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1554 in them.
1555
1556 +++
1557 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1558
1559 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
1560 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
1561 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
1562 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
1563
1564 ---
1565 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
1566 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
1567
1568 ---
1569 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1570
1571 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
1572 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
1573 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
1574 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
1575
1576 +++
1577 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
1578 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
1579
1580 ---
1581 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1582
1583 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
1584 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
1585 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
1586 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
1587 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
1588 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
1589
1590 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
1591 rectangle highlighting: Use C-return to start a rectangle, extend it
1592 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
1593 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
1594
1595 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
1596 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
1597 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
1598 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
1599 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
1600 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
1601 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
1602
1603 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
1604 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
1605 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
1606
1607 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
1608 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
1609
1610 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
1611 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
1612 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
1613 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
1614
1615 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
1616 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
1617 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you can customize the
1618 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
1619
1620 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
1621 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
1622 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
1623 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
1624
1625 +++
1626 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
1627 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
1628 to increment the SOA serial.
1629
1630 ---
1631 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
1632 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
1633 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
1634 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
1635 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method can
1636 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
1637
1638 +++
1639 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
1640 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
1641
1642 +++
1643 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
1644 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
1645 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
1646 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
1647 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
1648
1649 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
1650 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
1651 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
1652 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
1653 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
1654 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
1655
1656 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
1657 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
1658 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
1659 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
1660 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
1661 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
1662 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
1663 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
1664 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
1665 or local keymaps.
1666
1667 +++
1668 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
1669 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
1670
1671 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
1672 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
1673 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
1674 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
1675
1676 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
1677 defined macros.
1678
1679 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
1680 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
1681 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
1682 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
1683 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
1684 for more commands.
1685
1686 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
1687 the keyboard macro ring.
1688
1689 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
1690 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
1691
1692 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
1693 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
1694 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
1695 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
1696
1697 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
1698 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
1699 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
1700
1701 ---
1702 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
1703 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
1704 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
1705
1706 +++
1707 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
1708 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
1709
1710 +++
1711 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
1712 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
1713 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
1714 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
1715 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
1716 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
1717 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
1718 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
1719 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
1720
1721 +++
1722 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
1723
1724 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
1725 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
1726 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
1727 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
1728 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
1729 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
1730
1731 ---
1732 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
1733 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
1734 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
1735 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
1736
1737 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
1738
1739 ---
1740 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
1741 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
1742 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
1743 settings.
1744
1745 +++
1746 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
1747 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
1748 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
1749 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
1750
1751 +++
1752 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
1753 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
1754
1755 +++
1756 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
1757 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
1758 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
1759 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
1760 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
1761 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
1762
1763 +++
1764 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
1765 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
1766
1767 +++
1768 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
1769
1770 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
1771 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
1772 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
1773 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
1774 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
1775 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
1776 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
1777 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
1778 `rsync' to do the copying).
1779
1780 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
1781 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
1782
1783 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
1784
1785 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
1786
1787 ---
1788 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
1789
1790 ---
1791 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
1792 configuration files.
1793
1794 +++
1795 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
1796 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
1797 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
1798 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
1799 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
1800 recognized.
1801
1802 ---
1803 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
1804
1805 +++
1806 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
1807
1808 ---
1809 ** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
1810 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
1811 \f
1812 * Changes in Specialized Modes and Packages in Emacs 22.1:
1813
1814 ---
1815 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp and BSD make.
1816
1817 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter two
1818 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
1819 faces.
1820
1821 +++
1822 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
1823 of the file that precede the first header line.
1824
1825 +++
1826 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1827
1828 ---
1829 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved; it can
1830 run most curses applications now.
1831
1832 +++
1833 ** M-x diff uses Diff mode instead of Compilation mode.
1834
1835 +++
1836 ** You can now customize `fill-nobreak-predicate' to control where
1837 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
1838 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
1839
1840 Emacs provide two predicates, `fill-single-word-nobreak-p' and
1841 `fill-french-nobreak-p', for use as the value of
1842 `fill-nobreak-predicate'.
1843
1844 ---
1845 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
1846 with special modes such as Tar mode.
1847
1848 ---
1849 ** Commands `winner-redo' and `winner-undo', from winner.el, are now
1850 bound to C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an
1851 incompatible change.
1852
1853 ---
1854 ** `global-whitespace-mode' is a new alias for `whitespace-global-mode'.
1855
1856 +++
1857 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
1858 resync points in both windows.
1859
1860 +++
1861 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1862
1863 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1864 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1865
1866 ---
1867 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1868 when Emacs visits them.
1869
1870 ** Info mode changes:
1871
1872 +++
1873 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1874 with the number appended to the `*info*' buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1875
1876 ---
1877 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1878
1879 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1880 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1881 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1882 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1883 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1884 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1885 Info node.
1886
1887 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1888 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1889 search without prompting for a new search string.
1890
1891 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1892 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1893 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1894
1895 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1896
1897 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1898 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1899
1900 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1901 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1902 possible matches.
1903
1904 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1905 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1906 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1907
1908 ---
1909 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1910 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1911
1912 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1913 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1914
1915 +++
1916 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1917
1918 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1919 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1920
1921 ---
1922 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1923
1924 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1925 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1926 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1927
1928 +++
1929 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1930
1931 ---
1932 *** `Info-index' offers completion.
1933
1934 ** Lisp mode changes:
1935
1936 ---
1937 *** Lisp mode now uses `font-lock-doc-face' for doc strings.
1938
1939 +++
1940 *** C-u C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-prints the list after point.
1941
1942 *** New features in evaluation commands
1943
1944 +++
1945 **** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1946 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1947
1948 +++
1949 **** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1950 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1951 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1952 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1953 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1954
1955 +++
1956 ** CC mode changes.
1957
1958 *** Font lock support.
1959 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1960 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1961 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1962 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1963 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1964 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1965
1966 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1967 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1968 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1969 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1970 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1971 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1972 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1973 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1974 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1975
1976 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1977 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1978 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1979 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1980 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1981 take the better part of a minute.
1982
1983 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1984 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1985 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1986 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1987 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1988 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1989
1990 **** Support for documentation comments.
1991 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1992 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1993 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1994 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1995
1996 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1997 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1998 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1999 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2000
2001 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
2002 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
2003 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
2004 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
2005 parens.
2006
2007 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
2008 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
2009 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
2010 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
2011 not as configurable as it ought to be.
2012
2013 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
2014 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
2015 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
2016 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
2017 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
2018
2019 *** Support for the AWK language.
2020 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
2021 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
2022 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
2023 Here is a summary:
2024
2025 **** Indentation Engine
2026 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
2027
2028 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
2029 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
2030 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
2031 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
2032 definition, or structured statement.
2033
2034 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
2035 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
2036 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
2037
2038 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
2039 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
2040 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
2041 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
2042
2043 **** Font Locking
2044 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
2045 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
2046 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
2047 the AWK language itself.
2048
2049 **** Comment Commands
2050 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
2051 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
2052
2053 **** Movement Commands
2054 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
2055 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
2056 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
2057
2058 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
2059 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
2060 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
2061 functions.
2062
2063 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
2064 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
2065 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
2066 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
2067
2068 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
2069 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
2070 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
2071 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
2072 composition-close, and incomposition.
2073
2074 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
2075 The functions `c-hungry-backspace' and `c-hungry-delete-forward' can be
2076 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
2077
2078 *** Better control over `require-final-newline'.
2079
2080 The variable `c-require-final-newline' specifies which of the modes
2081 implemented by CC mode should insert final newlines. Its value is a
2082 list of modes, and only those modes should do it. By default the list
2083 includes C, C++ and Objective-C modes.
2084
2085 Whichever modes are in this list will set `require-final-newline'
2086 based on `mode-require-final-newline'.
2087
2088 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
2089
2090 The elements in the syntactic context returned by `c-guess-basic-syntax'
2091 and stored in `c-syntactic-context' has been changed somewhat to allow
2092 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2093 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2094
2095 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2096
2097 is now analysed as
2098
2099 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2100
2101 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2102 symbol.
2103
2104 This change might affect code that call `c-guess-basic-syntax' directly,
2105 and custom lineup functions if they use `c-syntactic-context'. However,
2106 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
2107 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
2108
2109 *** API changes for derived modes.
2110
2111 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2112 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2113 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2114 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2115 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2116
2117 **** New language variable system.
2118 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2119
2120 **** New initialization functions.
2121 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2122 give better control: `c-basic-common-init', `c-font-lock-init', and
2123 `c-init-language-vars'.
2124
2125 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2126 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2127 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2128 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2129
2130 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2131 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2132 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2133 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2134 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2135
2136 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2137 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2138 its substatement. E.g:
2139
2140 if (x)
2141 x_is_true:
2142 do_stuff();
2143
2144 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
2145
2146 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2147 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2148 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2149 variable `c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros'. A new syntactic symbol
2150 `cpp-define-intro' has been added to control the initial indentation
2151 inside `#define's.
2152
2153 **** New lineup function `c-lineup-cpp-define'.
2154
2155 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2156 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2157 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2158 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2159 much line `c-lineup-dont-change', which was used earlier, but handles
2160 empty lines within the macro better.
2161
2162 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2163 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2164 `c-context-line-break' and `c-context-open-line'.
2165
2166 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2167 `c-backslash-region' tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2168 variable `c-backslash-max-column' which put a limit on how far out
2169 backslashes can be moved.
2170
2171 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2172 This is controlled by the new variable `c-auto-align-backslashes'. It
2173 affects `c-context-line-break', `c-context-open-line' and newlines
2174 inserted in Auto-Newline mode.
2175 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2176
2177 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2178 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2179 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2180 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2181 backslash) in the macro.
2182
2183 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2184 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2185 the variable `c-indent-comment-alist'. The indentation behavior based
2186 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2187 and #endif but indentation to `comment-column' in most other cases
2188 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
2189
2190 *** New function `c-context-open-line'.
2191 It's the open-line equivalent of `c-context-line-break'.
2192
2193 *** New lineup functions
2194
2195 **** `c-lineup-string-cont'
2196 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2197 continues. E.g:
2198
2199 result = prefix + "A message "
2200 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2201
2202 **** `c-lineup-cascaded-calls'
2203 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2204
2205 **** `c-lineup-knr-region-comment'
2206 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2207 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2208
2209 **** `c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg'
2210 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks.
2211
2212 **** `c-lineup-argcont'
2213 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2214
2215 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2216 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2217 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2218 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2219 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2220 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2221
2222 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2223 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2224 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2225 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2226 context.
2227
2228 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2229 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2230 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2231 happen when macros are involved.
2232
2233 *** Improved the way `c-indent-exp' chooses the block to indent.
2234 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2235 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2236 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2237 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2238 line is left untouched.
2239
2240 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2241 The function `c-toggle-syntactic-indentation' can be used to toggle
2242 syntactic indentation.
2243
2244 ---
2245 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
2246
2247 ---
2248 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2249 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2250 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2251 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2252
2253 ** Fortran mode changes:
2254
2255 ---
2256 *** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
2257 highlighting for the old default.
2258
2259 +++
2260 *** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2261 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2262 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
2263
2264 +++
2265 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
2266 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
2267 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
2268 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
2269
2270 ---
2271 *** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for `hs-minor-mode' (hideshow).
2272 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2273 majority.
2274
2275 ---
2276 *** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2277 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2278
2279 ---
2280 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2281 to support use of font-lock.
2282
2283 ** HTML/SGML changes:
2284
2285 ---
2286 *** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2287 automatically.
2288
2289 +++
2290 *** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2291 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
2292 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2293 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2294 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2295 from the file name or buffer contents.
2296
2297 +++
2298 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2299
2300 ** TeX modes:
2301
2302 +++
2303 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
2304
2305 +++
2306 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
2307 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
2308 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
2309 TeX commands to use at startup.
2310
2311 ---
2312 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
2313 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
2314
2315 +++
2316 *** New major mode Doctex mode, for *.dtx files.
2317
2318 ** BibTeX mode:
2319
2320 *** The new command `bibtex-url' browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
2321 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
2322
2323 *** The new command `bibtex-entry-update' (bound to C-c C-u) updates
2324 an existing BibTeX entry.
2325
2326 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
2327
2328 *** `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' can take values `plain',
2329 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
2330 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
2331 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
2332 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
2333 `bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries' is non-nil.
2334
2335 *** If the new variable `bibtex-parse-keys-fast' is non-nil,
2336 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
2337
2338 *** If the new variable `bibtex-autoadd-commas' is non-nil,
2339 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
2340
2341 *** The new variable `bibtex-autofill-types' contains a list of entry
2342 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
2343
2344 *** The new command `bibtex-complete' completes word fragment before
2345 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
2346
2347 *** The new commands `bibtex-find-entry' and `bibtex-find-crossref'
2348 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
2349 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
2350
2351 *** In BibTeX mode the command `fill-paragraph' (M-q) fills
2352 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
2353
2354 *** The new variables `bibtex-files' and `bibtex-file-path' define a set
2355 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
2356
2357 *** The new command `bibtex-validate-globally' checks for duplicate keys
2358 in multiple BibTeX files.
2359
2360 *** The new command `bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill' pushes summary
2361 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
2362
2363 +++
2364 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2365 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2366 and `C-c C-r'.
2367
2368 ** GUD changes:
2369
2370 +++
2371 *** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
2372 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
2373
2374 ---
2375 *** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
2376 and other common debugger commands.
2377
2378 +++
2379 *** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2380 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2381 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2382 state of your program. It can separate the input/output of your program from
2383 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2384 Emacs 21/22 such as the the toolbar, and bitmaps in the fringe to indicate
2385 breakpoints.
2386
2387 Use M-x gdb to start GDB-UI.
2388
2389 *** The variable tooltip-gud-tips-p has been removed. GUD tooltips can now be
2390 toggled independently of normal tooltips with the minor mode
2391 `gud-tooltip-mode'.
2392
2393 +++
2394 *** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
2395 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
2396 not executing.
2397
2398 ---
2399 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
2400
2401 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
2402 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
2403 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
2404 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2405 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
2406
2407 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
2408 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
2409 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
2410 (gud-finish).
2411
2412 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
2413 (Java 1.1 jdb).
2414
2415 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
2416 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
2417 Set `gud-jdb-use-classpath' to nil.
2418
2419 Added Customization Variables
2420
2421 *** `gud-jdb-command-name'. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
2422
2423 *** `gud-jdb-use-classpath'. Allows selection of java source file searching
2424 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan `gud-jdb-directories' for
2425 java sources (previous method).
2426
2427 *** `gud-jdb-directories'. List of directories to scan and search for java
2428 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
2429 is nil).
2430
2431 Minor Improvements
2432
2433 *** The STARTTLS wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
2434 instead of the OpenSSL based `starttls' tool. For backwards
2435 compatibility, it prefers `starttls', but you can toggle
2436 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
2437 `starttls' tool).
2438
2439 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
2440
2441 ** Auto-Revert changes:
2442
2443 +++
2444 *** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
2445
2446 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
2447 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
2448 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
2449 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
2450 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
2451 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior can
2452 be mode dependent.
2453
2454 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
2455 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
2456 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
2457 toggles this mode.
2458
2459 +++
2460 *** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
2461 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
2462 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
2463 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
2464 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
2465 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
2466 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
2467 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
2468 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
2469
2470 +++
2471 *** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
2472 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
2473 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
2474 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
2475 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
2476
2477 ---
2478 ** recentf changes.
2479
2480 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
2481 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
2482 automatic cleanup.
2483
2484 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
2485 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
2486 keep in the recent list.
2487
2488 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
2489 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
2490 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
2491 recent list with different symbolic links.
2492
2493 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
2494 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
2495 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
2496
2497 +++
2498 ** Desktop package
2499
2500 +++
2501 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, `desktop-save-mode'.
2502
2503 +++
2504 *** The variable `desktop-enable' is obsolete.
2505
2506 Customize `desktop-save-mode' to enable desktop saving.
2507
2508 ---
2509 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
2510 buffer list.
2511
2512 +++
2513 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers
2514 immediately, remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is
2515 idle).
2516
2517 +++
2518 *** New commands:
2519 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
2520 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
2521 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
2522 it was loaded.
2523 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
2524 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
2525
2526 ---
2527 *** New customizable variables:
2528 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
2529 killed.
2530 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
2531 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
2532 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
2533 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
2534 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
2535 should not delete.
2536 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
2537 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
2538 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
2539 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
2540
2541 +++
2542 *** New command line option --no-desktop
2543
2544 ---
2545 *** New hooks:
2546 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
2547 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
2548
2549 ---
2550 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
2551
2552 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
2553 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
2554 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
2555 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
2556 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
2557 feature.
2558
2559 ** EDiff changes.
2560
2561 +++
2562 *** When comparing directories.
2563 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
2564 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
2565 from one directory to another.
2566
2567 +++
2568 *** When comparing files or buffers.
2569 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
2570 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
2571 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
2572 comparison.
2573
2574 +++
2575 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
2576 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
2577 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
2578
2579 +++
2580 ** Etags changes.
2581
2582 *** New regular expressions features
2583
2584 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
2585
2586 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
2587 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
2588 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
2589 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
2590 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
2591 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
2592 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
2593 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
2594 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
2595 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
2596
2597 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in GCC.
2598
2599 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
2600 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
2601 CR, TAB, VT,
2602
2603 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
2604
2605 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
2606 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
2607 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
2608
2609 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
2610
2611 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
2612 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
2613
2614 *** New language parsing features
2615
2616 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
2617
2618 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
2619
2620 **** The GCC __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
2621
2622 **** New language HTML.
2623
2624 Tags are generated for `title' as well as `h1', `h2', and `h3'. Also,
2625 when `name=' is used inside an anchor and whenever `id=' is used.
2626
2627 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
2628
2629 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
2630 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
2631
2632 **** New language Lua.
2633
2634 All functions are tagged.
2635
2636 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
2637
2638 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
2639 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
2640 package::sub.
2641
2642 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
2643
2644 **** New language PHP.
2645
2646 Functions, classes and defines are tags. If the --members option is
2647 specified to etags, variables are tags also.
2648
2649 **** New default keywords for TeX.
2650
2651 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
2652 renewenvironment.
2653
2654 *** Honour #line directives.
2655
2656 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
2657 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
2658 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
2659 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
2660 writes tags pointing to the source file.
2661
2662 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
2663
2664 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
2665 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
2666 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
2667 the file FILE.
2668
2669 ** VC Changes
2670
2671 +++
2672 *** The key C-x C-q only changes the read-only state of the buffer
2673 (toggle-read-only). It no longer checks files in or out.
2674
2675 We made this change because we held a poll and found that many users
2676 were unhappy with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this
2677 behavior, you can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your
2678 `.emacs' file:
2679
2680 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
2681
2682 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
2683
2684 +++
2685 *** The new variable `vc-cvs-global-switches' specifies switches that
2686 are passed to any CVS command invoked by VC.
2687
2688 These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which means they
2689 are inserted before the command name. For example, this allows you to
2690 specify a compression level using the `-z#' option for CVS.
2691
2692 +++
2693 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
2694
2695 +++
2696 *** VC-Annotate mode enhancements
2697
2698 In VC-Annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2699 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2700 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2701
2702 P: annotates the previous revision
2703 N: annotates the next revision
2704 J: annotates the revision at line
2705 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2706 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2707 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2708 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2709
2710 ** pcl-cvs changes:
2711
2712 +++
2713 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2714 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2715 in the repository.
2716
2717 +++
2718 *** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2719 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2720 `checkout', `update' or `commit'. That means using cvs diff options
2721 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2722
2723 +++
2724 ** The new variable `mail-default-directory' specifies
2725 `default-directory' for mail buffers. This directory is used for
2726 auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to "~/".
2727
2728 +++
2729 ** The mode line can indicate new mail in a directory or file.
2730
2731 See the documentation of the user option
2732 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2733
2734 ** Rmail changes:
2735
2736 ---
2737 *** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2738
2739 +++
2740 *** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2741
2742 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2743 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2744 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2745 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2746 used instead of the native one.
2747
2748 ** Gnus package
2749
2750 ---
2751 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2752
2753 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2754 PGP/MIME.
2755
2756 ---
2757 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2758
2759 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2760
2761 ---
2762 ** MH-E changes.
2763
2764 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.84. There have been major changes since
2765 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2766
2767 ** Calendar changes:
2768
2769 +++
2770 *** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2771 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2772
2773 +++
2774 *** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2775 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2776 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2777 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2778 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2779 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2780 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2781 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2782 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2783
2784 +++
2785 *** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2786 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2787 count backward from the end of the year.
2788
2789 +++
2790 *** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2791 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2792 day of that ISO week.
2793
2794 ---
2795 *** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2796 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2797
2798 ---
2799 *** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2800 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2801 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2802 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2803
2804 ---
2805 *** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2806 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2807 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2808
2809 +++
2810 *** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed:
2811 use the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2812 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2813 `appt-issue-message', `appt-visible', and `appt-msg-window'.
2814
2815 +++
2816 *** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2817 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2818 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2819 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2820 formats.
2821
2822 ---
2823 ** sql changes.
2824
2825 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2826 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2827 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2828 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2829 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2830
2831 The following values are supported:
2832
2833 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2834 db2 DB2
2835 informix Informix
2836 ingres Ingres
2837 interbase Interbase
2838 linter Linter
2839 ms Microsoft
2840 mysql MySQL
2841 oracle Oracle
2842 postgres Postgres
2843 solid Solid
2844 sqlite SQLite
2845 sybase Sybase
2846
2847 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2848 SQL mode indicator.
2849
2850 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2851 your `.emacs' will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2852 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
2853
2854 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
2855
2856 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2857 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2858 all identifiers ending in `_t' under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2859 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
2860
2861 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2862 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
2863
2864 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i.
2865
2866 Most SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
2867 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
2868
2869 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
2870
2871 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
2872 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
2873 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
2874 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
2875 terminated.
2876
2877 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
2878 called with the `-E' command line argument to use the operating system
2879 credentials to authenticate the user.
2880
2881 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
2882 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
2883 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
2884
2885 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
2886 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
2887
2888 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
2889 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
2890 defaults.
2891
2892 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
2893 appropriate `sql-interactive-mode' wrapper for the current setting of
2894 `sql-product'.
2895
2896 ---
2897 *** sql.el supports the SQLite interpreter--call 'sql-sqlite'.
2898
2899 ** FFAP changes:
2900
2901 +++
2902 *** New ffap commands and keybindings:
2903
2904 C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
2905 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
2906 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
2907 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
2908
2909 ---
2910 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default.
2911
2912 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
2913 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
2914
2915 ---
2916 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
2917
2918 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
2919 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
2920 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
2921 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
2922 with other details of skeleton construction.
2923
2924 ---
2925 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2926 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2927 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2928 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2929
2930 +++
2931 ** `hide-ifdef-mode' now uses overlays rather than selective-display
2932 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
2933 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
2934
2935 ---
2936 ** `partial-completion-mode' now handles partial completion on directory names.
2937
2938 ---
2939 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
2940 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
2941 you don't want the `.type-break' file in your home directory or are
2942 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
2943
2944 ---
2945 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
2946
2947 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
2948 `ps-print', provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF
2949 fonts. See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
2950
2951 ---
2952 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
2953 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
2954 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
2955 using strokes as an input method.
2956
2957 ** Emacs server changes:
2958
2959 +++
2960 *** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
2961
2962 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
2963 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
2964 % emacsclient -s foo file1
2965 % emacsclient -s bar file2
2966
2967 +++
2968 *** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
2969 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given Lisp
2970 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
2971
2972 +++
2973 *** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
2974
2975 ---
2976 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
2977
2978 +++
2979 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
2980
2981 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
2982 argument it toggles the mode. Turning off PC-Selection mode restores
2983 the global key bindings that were replaced by turning on the mode.
2984
2985 ---
2986 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
2987 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
2988
2989 ---
2990 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2991
2992 Emacs still works on terminals that require magic cookies in order to
2993 use standout mode, but they can no longer display mode-lines in
2994 inverse-video.
2995
2996 ---
2997 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
2998
2999 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
3000 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
3001 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
3002
3003 ---
3004 ** display-battery-mode replaces display-battery.
3005
3006 ---
3007 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode.
3008
3009 To enable this, set `calculator-output-radix' non-nil. In this mode a
3010 separator character is used every few digits, making it easier to see
3011 byte boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the
3012 variable `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
3013
3014 ---
3015 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
3016
3017 ---
3018 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3019
3020 ---
3021 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3022 \f
3023 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3024
3025 +++
3026 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
3027
3028 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
3029 existing values. For example:
3030
3031 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
3032
3033 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
3034 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
3035
3036 ---
3037 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
3038
3039 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
3040 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
3041
3042 ---
3043 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
3044
3045 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
3046
3047 ---
3048 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
3049
3050 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
3051 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
3052 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
3053 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
3054 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
3055 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
3056
3057 ---
3058 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
3059
3060 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
3061 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
3062 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
3063 sound support for those formats.
3064
3065 ---
3066 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
3067
3068 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
3069
3070 ---
3071 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
3072
3073 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
3074 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
3075 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
3076
3077 ---
3078 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
3079
3080 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
3081 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
3082 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
3083 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
3084 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
3085 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
3086 you wish to use them in other faces.
3087
3088 ---
3089 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
3090
3091 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
3092 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
3093 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
3094 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
3095 any customizations.
3096
3097 ---
3098 ** On Mac OS, `keyboard-coding-system' changes based on the keyboard script.
3099
3100 ---
3101 ** The variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
3102 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
3103 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
3104 \f
3105 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3106
3107 ---
3108 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3109 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3110
3111 +++
3112 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
3113 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
3114 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
3115 `undefined'.)
3116
3117 +++
3118 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
3119 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
3120 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
3121
3122 ---
3123 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3124 \f
3125 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3126
3127 ** General Lisp changes:
3128
3129 +++
3130 *** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3131
3132 +++
3133 *** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3134
3135 +++
3136 *** `add-to-list' takes an optional third argument, APPEND.
3137
3138 If APPEND is non-nil, the new element gets added at the end of the
3139 list instead of at the beginning. This change actually occurred in
3140 Emacs 21.1, but was not documented then.
3141
3142 +++
3143 *** New function `add-to-ordered-list' is like `add-to-list' but
3144 associates a numeric ordering of each element added to the list.
3145
3146 +++
3147 *** New function `copy-tree' makes a copy of a tree.
3148
3149 It recursively copyies through both CARs and CDRs.
3150
3151 +++
3152 *** New function `delete-dups' deletes `equal' duplicate elements from a list.
3153
3154 It modifies the list destructively, like `delete'. Of several `equal'
3155 occurrences of an element in the list, the one that's kept is the
3156 first one.
3157
3158 +++
3159 *** New function `rassq-delete-all'.
3160
3161 (rassq-delete-all VALUE ALIST) deletes, from ALIST, each element whose
3162 CDR is `eq' to the specified value.
3163
3164 +++
3165 *** The function `number-sequence' makes a list of equally-separated numbers.
3166
3167 For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9). By
3168 default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different
3169 separation as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns
3170 (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3171
3172 +++
3173 *** New variables `most-positive-fixnum' and `most-negative-fixnum'.
3174
3175 They hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
3176
3177 +++
3178 *** Minor change in the function `format'.
3179
3180 Some flags that were accepted but not implemented (such as "*") are no
3181 longer accepted.
3182
3183 +++
3184 *** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer give errors for bad plists.
3185
3186 They return nil for a malformed property list or if the list is
3187 cyclic.
3188
3189 +++
3190 *** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
3191
3192 They are like `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare
3193 the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
3194
3195 +++
3196 *** New variable `print-continuous-numbering'.
3197
3198 When this is non-nil, successive calls to print functions use a single
3199 numbering scheme for circular structure references. This is only
3200 relevant when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3201
3202 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3203 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3204
3205 +++
3206 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3207
3208 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3209 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3210 if no expansion is done, which can be tested using `eq'.
3211
3212 +++
3213 *** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
3214
3215 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
3216 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
3217 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
3218
3219 +++
3220 *** A function or macro's doc string can now specify the calling pattern.
3221
3222 You put this info in the doc string's last line. It should be
3223 formatted so as to match the regexp "\n\n(fn .*)\\'". If you don't
3224 specify this explicitly, Emacs determines it from the actual argument
3225 names. Usually that default is right, but not always.
3226
3227 +++
3228 *** New macro `with-local-quit' temporarily allows quitting.
3229
3230 A quit inside the body of `with-local-quit' is caught by the
3231 `with-local-quit' form itself, but another quit will happen later once
3232 the code that has inhibitted quitting exits.
3233
3234 This is for use around potentially blocking or long-running code
3235 inside timer functions and `post-command-hook' functions.
3236
3237 +++
3238 *** New macro `define-obsolete-function-alias'.
3239
3240 This combines `defalias' and `make-obsolete'.
3241
3242 +++
3243 *** New function `unsafep' determines whether a Lisp form is safe.
3244
3245 It returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly do anything
3246 dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be unsafe
3247 (calls unknown function, alters global variable, etc).
3248
3249 *** `list-faces-display' takes an optional argument, REGEXP.
3250
3251 If it is non-nil, the function lists only faces matching this regexp.
3252
3253 ** Lisp code indentation features:
3254
3255 +++
3256 *** The `defmacro' form can contain indentation and edebug declarations.
3257
3258 These declarations specify how to indent the macro calls in Lisp mode
3259 and how to debug them with Edebug. You write them like this:
3260
3261 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3262
3263 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3264 possible declaration specifiers are:
3265
3266 (indent INDENT)
3267 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3268
3269 (edebug DEBUG)
3270 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3271 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro,
3272 but this is cleaner.)
3273
3274 ---
3275 *** cl-indent now allows customization of Indentation of backquoted forms.
3276
3277 See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
3278
3279 ---
3280 *** cl-indent now handles indentation of simple and extended `loop' forms.
3281
3282 The new user options `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation',
3283 `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can
3284 be used to customize the indentation of keywords and forms in loop
3285 forms.
3286
3287 +++
3288 ** Variable aliases:
3289
3290 *** New function: defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
3291
3292 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
3293 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
3294 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
3295 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
3296
3297 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
3298 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
3299
3300 *** New function: indirect-variable VARIABLE
3301
3302 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
3303 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
3304 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
3305
3306 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
3307 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
3308
3309 +++
3310 *** The macro `define-obsolete-variable-alias' combines `defvaralias' and
3311 `make-obsolete-variable'.
3312
3313 ** defcustom changes:
3314
3315 +++
3316 *** The new customization type `float' requires a floating point number.
3317
3318 ** String changes:
3319
3320 +++
3321 *** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character.
3322
3323 Exception: In a character constant, if it is followed by a `-' in a
3324 character constant (e.g. ?\s-A), it is still interpreted as the super
3325 modifier. In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3326
3327 +++
3328 *** A hex escape in a string constant forces the string to be multibyte.
3329
3330 +++
3331 *** An octal escape in a string constant forces the string to be unibyte.
3332
3333 +++
3334 *** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3335 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3336 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3337 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3338 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3339
3340 +++
3341 *** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3342 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3343
3344 +++
3345 *** New function `substring-no-properties' returns a substring without
3346 text properties.
3347
3348 +++
3349 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
3350 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
3351 been declared obsolete.
3352
3353 +++
3354 ** Displaying warnings to the user.
3355
3356 See the functions `warn' and `display-warning', or the Lisp Manual.
3357 If you want to be sure the warning will not be overlooked, this
3358 facility is much better than using `message', since it displays
3359 warnings in a separate window.
3360
3361 +++
3362 ** Progress reporters.
3363
3364 These provide a simple and uniform way for commands to present
3365 progress messages for the user.
3366
3367 See the new functions `make-progress-reporter',
3368 `progress-reporter-update', `progress-reporter-force-update',
3369 `progress-reporter-done', and `dotimes-with-progress-reporter'.
3370
3371 ** Buffer positions:
3372
3373 +++
3374 *** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3375 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3376 the usable window height and width is used.
3377
3378 +++
3379 *** The `line-move', `scroll-up', and `scroll-down' functions will now
3380 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3381 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presence of
3382 large images. To disable this feature, bind the new variable
3383 `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3384
3385 +++
3386 *** The argument to `forward-word', `backward-word' is optional.
3387
3388 It defaults to 1.
3389
3390 +++
3391 *** Argument to `forward-to-indentation' and `backward-to-indentation' is optional.
3392
3393 It defaults to 1.
3394
3395 +++
3396 *** New function `mouse-on-link-p' test if a position is in a clickable link.
3397
3398 This is the function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link'
3399 functionality.
3400
3401 +++
3402 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of a position.
3403
3404 It an optional buffer position argument that defaults to point.
3405
3406 +++
3407 *** `field-beginning' and `field-end' take new optional argument, LIMIT.
3408
3409 This argument tells them not to search beyond LIMIT. Instead they
3410 give up and return LIMIT.
3411
3412 +++
3413 *** Function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now returns the pixel coordinates
3414 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3415 arg is non-nil.
3416
3417 +++
3418 *** New functions `posn-at-point' and `posn-at-x-y' return
3419 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
3420 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
3421
3422 ** Text modification:
3423
3424 +++
3425 *** The new function `insert-for-yank' normally works like `insert', but
3426 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list
3427 and handles the `yank-handler' text property.
3428
3429 +++
3430 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-as-yank' is like
3431 `insert-for-yank' except that it gets the text from another buffer as
3432 in `insert-buffer-substring'.
3433
3434 +++
3435 *** The new function `insert-buffer-substring-no-properties' is like
3436 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes all text properties from the
3437 inserted substring.
3438
3439 +++
3440 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
3441 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
3442 the filtered substring. Use it instead of `buffer-substring' or
3443 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
3444 data structure, such as the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register.
3445
3446 The list of filter function is specified by the new variable
3447 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode adds to
3448 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
3449 text.
3450
3451 +++
3452 *** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
3453 argument.
3454
3455 +++
3456 *** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3457 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3458 be inserted is translated through it.
3459
3460 ---
3461 *** Text clones.
3462
3463 The new function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
3464 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
3465 clone to the other.
3466
3467 ---
3468 *** The function `insert-string' is now obsolete.
3469
3470 ** Filling changes.
3471
3472 +++
3473 *** In determining an adaptive fill prefix, Emacs now tries the function in
3474 `adaptive-fill-function' _before_ matching the buffer line against
3475 `adaptive-fill-regexp' rather than _after_ it.
3476
3477 +++
3478 ** Atomic change groups.
3479
3480 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3481 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3482 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3483
3484 (atomic-change-group
3485 (insert foo)
3486 (delete-region x y))
3487
3488 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3489 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3490 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3491 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3492
3493 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3494 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3495
3496 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3497 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3498 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3499 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3500
3501 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3502 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3503 do this.
3504
3505 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3506 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3507 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3508 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3509
3510 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3511 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3512 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3513 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3514 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3515 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3516 twice.
3517
3518 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3519 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3520 returned values, like this:
3521
3522 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3523 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3524
3525 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3526 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3527 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3528
3529 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3530 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3531 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3532 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3533 finished.
3534
3535 ** Buffer-related changes:
3536
3537 ---
3538 *** `list-buffers-noselect' now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
3539
3540 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
3541
3542 +++
3543 *** `kill-buffer-hook' is now a permanent local.
3544
3545 +++
3546 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
3547 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
3548 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
3549 value of VARIABLE instead.
3550
3551 ** Local variables lists:
3552
3553 +++
3554 *** Text properties in local variables.
3555
3556 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
3557 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
3558
3559 +++
3560 *** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3561 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3562 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3563 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3564 needed.
3565
3566 ---
3567 *** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3568 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3569 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3570 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3571 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3572 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3573
3574 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3575 confirmation as before.
3576
3577 ** Searching and matching changes:
3578
3579 +++
3580 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
3581 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
3582 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
3583
3584 +++
3585 *** The new variable `search-spaces-regexp' controls how to search
3586 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
3587 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
3588 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
3589
3590 Spaces inside of constructs such as `[..]' and inside loops such as
3591 `*', `+', and `?' are never replaced with `search-spaces-regexp'.
3592
3593 +++
3594 *** New regular expression operators, `\_<' and `\_>'.
3595
3596 These match the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
3597 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
3598 specified by the syntax table.
3599
3600 ---
3601 *** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
3602
3603 +++
3604 *** `skip-chars-forward' and `skip-chars-backward' now handle
3605 character classes such as `[:alpha:]', along with individual
3606 characters and ranges.
3607
3608 ---
3609 *** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
3610 properties from surrounding text.
3611
3612 +++
3613 *** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
3614 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
3615 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
3616
3617 +++
3618 *** Functions `match-data' and `set-match-data' now have an optional
3619 argument `reseat'. When non-nil, all markers in the match data list
3620 passed to these function will be reseated to point to nowhere, and if
3621 the value of `reseat' is `evaporate', the markers are put onto the
3622 free list. Note that no other references to those markers must exist
3623 if `evaporate' is specified for the `reseat' argument.
3624
3625 +++
3626 *** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3627 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
3628 that end a sentence without following spaces.
3629
3630 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
3631 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
3632 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3633 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3634 `sentence-end-without-space'.
3635
3636 ** Undo changes:
3637
3638 +++
3639 *** `buffer-undo-list' can allows programmable elements.
3640
3641 These elements have the form (apply FUNNAME . ARGS), where FUNNAME is
3642 a symbol other than t or nil. That stands for a high-level change
3643 that should be undone by evaluating (apply FUNNAME ARGS).
3644
3645 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3646 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3647 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3648
3649 +++
3650 *** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3651 `undo-outer-limit', garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3652 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3653
3654 +++
3655 ** New `yank-handler' text property can be used to control how
3656 previously killed text on the kill ring is reinserted.
3657
3658 The value of the `yank-handler' property must be a list with one to four
3659 elements with the following format:
3660 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3661
3662 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3663 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3664 element on the kill-ring). If a `yank-handler' property is found,
3665 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3666
3667 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3668 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3669 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3670 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3671 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3672 rectangle.
3673 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3674 `yank-excluded-properties' is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3675 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3676 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3677 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3678 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3679 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3680 FUNCTION can set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3681
3682 *** The functions `kill-new', `kill-append', and `kill-region' now have an
3683 optional argument to specify the `yank-handler' text property to put on
3684 the killed text.
3685
3686 *** The function `yank-pop' will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3687 `yank-undo-function' (instead of `delete-region') to undo the previous
3688 `yank' or `yank-pop' command (or a call to `insert-for-yank'). The function
3689 `insert-for-yank' automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3690 element of the string argument's `yank-handler' text property if present.
3691
3692 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3693 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3694 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3695 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3696
3697 ** Syntax table changes:
3698
3699 +++
3700 *** The macro `with-syntax-table' no longer copies the syntax table.
3701
3702 +++
3703 *** The new function `syntax-after' returns the syntax code
3704 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
3705 of text properties as well as the character code.
3706
3707 +++
3708 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
3709 by `syntax-after').
3710
3711 *** The new function `syntax-ppss' rovides an efficient way to find the
3712 current syntactic context at point.
3713
3714 ** File operation changes:
3715
3716 +++
3717 *** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
3718 searching for an executable or an Emacs Lisp file.
3719
3720 +++
3721 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
3722 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
3723 operation.
3724
3725 +++
3726 *** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3727 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3728 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
3729 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
3730
3731 +++
3732 *** `buffer-auto-save-file-format' is the new name for what was
3733 formerly called `auto-save-file-format'. It is now a permanent local.
3734
3735 +++
3736 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
3737 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
3738 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
3739
3740 +++
3741 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
3742
3743 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
3744
3745 +++
3746 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
3747 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
3748
3749 +++
3750 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
3751 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3752 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3753 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3754
3755 +++
3756 *** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3757 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3758 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3759 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3760
3761 +++
3762 *** If `buffer-save-without-query' is non-nil in some buffer,
3763 `save-some-buffers' will always save that buffer without asking (if
3764 it's modified).
3765
3766 +++
3767 *** New function `locate-file' searches for a file in a list of directories.
3768 `locate-file' accepts a name of a file to search (a string), and two
3769 lists: a list of directories to search in and a list of suffixes to
3770 try; typical usage might use `exec-path' and `load-path' for the list
3771 of directories, and `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' for the list
3772 of suffixes. The function also accepts a predicate argument to
3773 further filter candidate files.
3774
3775 One advantage of using this function is that the list of suffixes in
3776 `exec-suffixes' is OS-dependant, so this function will find
3777 executables without polluting Lisp code with OS dependancies.
3778
3779 ---
3780 *** The precedence of file name handlers has been changed.
3781
3782 Instead of choosing the first handler that matches,
3783 `find-file-name-handler' now gives precedence to a file name handler
3784 that matches nearest the end of the file name. More precisely, the
3785 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen. In case
3786 of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3787
3788 +++
3789 *** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3790
3791 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3792 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3793 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3794 operations.
3795
3796 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
3797 autoloaded when not really necessary.
3798
3799 ** Input changes:
3800
3801 +++
3802 *** An interactive specification can now use the code letter 'U' to get
3803 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
3804 previous `k' or `K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
3805
3806 +++
3807 *** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
3808 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
3809 it returns just the directory name.
3810
3811 ---
3812 *** Functions `y-or-n-p', `read-char', `read-key-sequence' and the like, that
3813 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
3814 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
3815
3816 +++
3817 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
3818 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
3819 quit had occurred. `while-no-input' returns the value of BODY, if BODY
3820 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
3821
3822 ** Minibuffer changes:
3823
3824 +++
3825 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
3826 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
3827 defaults to the current buffer.
3828
3829 +++
3830 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
3831 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
3832
3833 +++
3834 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
3835 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
3836
3837 +++
3838 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3839 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3840 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3841 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3842 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3843
3844 ---
3845 *** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by Lisp code
3846 to override the built-in `read-file-name' function.
3847
3848 +++
3849 *** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3850 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3851 `read-file-name' function.
3852
3853 +++
3854 *** The new function `read-directory-name' for reading a directory name.
3855
3856 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
3857 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
3858
3859 ** Completion changes:
3860
3861 +++
3862 *** The functions `all-completions' and `try-completion' now accept lists
3863 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3864 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3865 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables can be either
3866 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
3867
3868 +++
3869 *** The new macro `dynamic-completion-table' supports using functions
3870 as a dynamic completion table.
3871
3872 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3873
3874 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
3875 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
3876 completions. This alist can be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
3877 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3878 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3879 entered. `dynamic-completion-table' then computes the completion.
3880
3881 +++
3882 *** The new macro `lazy-completion-table' initializes a variable
3883 as a lazy completion table.
3884
3885 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3886
3887 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3888 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3889 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3890 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3891 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3892 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3893
3894 +++
3895 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
3896
3897 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
3898
3899 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
3900 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
3901 example,
3902
3903 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
3904
3905 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3906
3907 This is an alternative to using `defadvice' or `substitute-key-definition'
3908 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
3909 binding and lookup functionality.
3910
3911 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3912 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3913 original command.
3914
3915 Example:
3916 Suppose that minor mode `my-mode' has defined the commands
3917 `my-kill-line' and `my-kill-word', and it wants C-k (and any other key
3918 bound to `kill-line') to run the command `my-kill-line' instead of
3919 `kill-line', and likewise it wants to run `my-kill-word' instead of
3920 `kill-word'.
3921
3922 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3923 command remapping allows you to directly map `kill-line' into
3924 `my-kill-line' and `kill-word' into `my-kill-word' using `define-key':
3925
3926 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3927 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3928
3929 When `my-mode' is enabled, its minor mode keymap is enabled too. So
3930 when the user types C-k, that runs the command `my-kill-line'.
3931
3932 Only one level of remapping is supported. In the above example, this
3933 means that if `my-kill-line' is remapped to `other-kill', then C-k still
3934 runs `my-kill-line'.
3935
3936 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3937
3938 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3939 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3940 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3941 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3942
3943 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3944 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3945
3946 - `key-binding' now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3947 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3948
3949 - `where-is-internal' now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3950 `kill-line', when `my-mode' is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3951 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3952 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3953 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns "C-k" for `kill-line', and
3954 "<kill-line>" for `my-kill-line').
3955
3956 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3957 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3958 command was not remapped.
3959
3960 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3961 over minor mode keymaps.
3962
3963 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3964 text properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3965 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3966
3967 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3968
3969 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3970 bindings of the parent keymap.
3971
3972 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3973
3974 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
3975 active keymaps.
3976
3977 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
3978 defined keys and their definitions.
3979
3980 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt string of a keymap.
3981
3982 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3983 in the keymap.
3984
3985 *** New variable `emulation-mode-map-alists'.
3986
3987 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3988 keymap alist separate from `minor-mode-map-alist' by adding their
3989 keymap alist to this list.
3990
3991 ** Abbrev changes:
3992
3993 +++
3994 *** The new function `copy-abbrev-table' copies an abbrev table.
3995
3996 It returns a new abbrev table that is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3997
3998 +++
3999 *** `define-abbrev' now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG.
4000
4001 If non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means
4002 that it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the
4003 abbrevs. Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always
4004 specify this flag.
4005
4006 +++
4007 ** Enhancements to process support
4008
4009 *** Function `list-processes' now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
4010 it lists only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set.
4011
4012 *** New fns `set-process-query-on-exit-flag' and `process-query-on-exit-flag'.
4013
4014 These replace the old function `process-kill-without-query'. That
4015 function is still supported, but new code should use the new
4016 functions.
4017
4018 *** Function `signal-process' now accepts a process object or process
4019 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
4020
4021 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
4022 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
4023
4024 Use the new functions `process-get' and `process-put' to access, add,
4025 and modify elements on this property list. Use the new functions
4026 `process-plist' and `set-process-plist' to access and replace the
4027 entire property list of a process.
4028
4029 *** Function `accept-process-output' has a new optional fourth arg
4030 JUST-THIS-ONE. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
4031 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
4032 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
4033 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
4034 speech synthesis.
4035
4036 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
4037
4038 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
4039 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4040 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
4041 by setting the new variable `process-adaptive-read-buffering' to a
4042 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
4043 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
4044 emacs tries to read it.
4045
4046 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command'.
4047
4048 This executes a shell command command synchronously in a separate
4049 process.
4050
4051 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
4052 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
4053 `default-directory'.
4054
4055 *** A process filter function gets the output as multibyte string
4056 if the process specifies t for its filter's multibyteness.
4057
4058 That multibyteness is decided by the value of
4059 `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is created, and
4060 you can change it later with `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
4061
4062 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
4063 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4064
4065 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns the
4066 multibyteness of the strings passed to the process's filter.
4067
4068 *** If a process's coding system is `raw-text' or `no-conversion' and its
4069 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
4070 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
4071 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4072 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
4073
4074 +++
4075 ** Enhanced networking support.
4076
4077 *** The new `make-network-process' function makes network connections.
4078 It allows opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
4079 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
4080
4081 - A server is started using :server t arg.
4082 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
4083 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
4084 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
4085 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
4086 - The process' property list can be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
4087 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
4088 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
4089
4090 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
4091 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
4092
4093 *** The old `open-network-stream' now uses `make-network-process'.
4094
4095 *** New functions `process-datagram-address', `set-process-datagram-address'.
4096
4097 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
4098 and set the current address of the remote partner.
4099
4100 *** New function `format-network-address'.
4101
4102 This function reformats the Lisp representation of a network address
4103 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
4104 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
4105 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
4106 string for other formatting options.
4107
4108 *** `process-contact' has an optional KEY argument.
4109
4110 Depending on this argument, you can get the complete list of network
4111 process properties or a specific property. Using :local or :remote as
4112 the KEY, you get the address of the local or remote end-point.
4113
4114 An Inet address is represented as a 5 element vector, where the first
4115 4 elements contain the IP address and the fifth is the port number.
4116
4117 *** New functions `stop-process' and `continue-process'.
4118
4119 These functions stop and restart communication through a network
4120 connection. For a server process, no connections are accepted in the
4121 stopped state. For a client process, no input is received in the
4122 stopped state.
4123
4124 *** New function `network-interface-list'.
4125
4126 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
4127 current network addresses.
4128
4129 *** New function `network-interface-info'.
4130
4131 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
4132 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
4133
4134 *** Deleting a network process with `delete-process' calls the sentinel.
4135
4136 The status message passed to the sentinel for a deleted network
4137 process is "deleted". The message passed to the sentinel when the
4138 connection is closed by the remote peer has been changed to
4139 "connection broken by remote peer".
4140
4141 ** Using window objects:
4142
4143 +++
4144 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4145
4146 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line or the
4147 header line.
4148
4149 +++
4150 *** New function `window-body-height'.
4151
4152 This is like `window-height' but does not count the mode line
4153 or the header line.
4154
4155 +++
4156 *** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4157
4158 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4159 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4160 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4161 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4162 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4163
4164 +++
4165 *** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
4166 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
4167 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
4168 the mode line.
4169
4170 +++
4171 *** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
4172 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
4173
4174 +++
4175 *** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
4176 selected window without impacting the order of `buffer-list'.
4177
4178 +++
4179 *** `select-window' takes an optional second argument NORECORD.
4180
4181 This is like `switch-to-buffer'.
4182
4183 +++
4184 *** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
4185 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
4186 by calling `select-window'.
4187
4188 +++
4189 *** `set-window-buffer' has an optional argument KEEP-MARGINS.
4190
4191 If non-nil, that says to preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
4192 and scroll-bar settings.
4193
4194 +++
4195 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
4196
4197 *** New function `define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
4198 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
4199
4200 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
4201 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
4202
4203 *** New function `destroy-fringe-bitmap' deletes a fringe bitmap
4204 or restores a built-in one to its default value.
4205
4206 *** New function `set-fringe-bitmap-face' specifies the face to be
4207 used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is automatically merged
4208 with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face should only specify the
4209 foreground color of the bitmap.
4210
4211 *** There are new display properties, `left-fringe' and `right-fringe',
4212 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
4213 bitmap of the display line.
4214
4215 Format is `display (left-fringe BITMAP [FACE])', where BITMAP is a
4216 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
4217 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
4218 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
4219 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
4220
4221 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
4222 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
4223
4224 ** Other window fringe features:
4225
4226 +++
4227 *** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
4228
4229 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
4230 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
4231 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
4232 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
4233
4234 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
4235 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
4236 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
4237 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
4238 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
4239 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
4240
4241 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
4242 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
4243 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
4244 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
4245
4246 +++
4247 *** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
4248
4249 **** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
4250 position settings.
4251
4252 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
4253 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
4254 `set-window-fringes'.
4255
4256 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
4257 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
4258 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
4259 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
4260
4261 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
4262 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
4263 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
4264 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
4265 an update of the display margins.
4266
4267 **** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
4268 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
4269
4270 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
4271 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
4272 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
4273 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
4274 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
4275 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
4276 of the display margins.
4277
4278 ** Redisplay features:
4279
4280 +++
4281 *** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
4282
4283 +++
4284 *** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
4285 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
4286 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
4287 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
4288 forcing an explicit window update.
4289
4290 +++
4291 *** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
4292 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
4293 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
4294
4295 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
4296 does that, this value cannot be accurate.
4297
4298 +++
4299 *** You can define multiple overlay arrows via the new
4300 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'.
4301
4302 It contains a list of varibles which contain overlay arrow position
4303 markers, including the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
4304
4305 Each variable on this list can have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
4306 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
4307 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
4308 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
4309 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
4310 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
4311
4312 +++
4313 *** New `line-height' and `line-spacing' properties for newline characters
4314
4315 A newline can now have `line-height' and `line-spacing' text or overlay
4316 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
4317
4318 If the `line-height' property value is t, the newline does not
4319 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
4320 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a `line-spacing' property on this
4321 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
4322 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
4323
4324 If the `line-height' property value is a positive integer, the value
4325 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
4326 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
4327
4328 If the `line-height' property value is a float, the minimum line
4329 height is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by
4330 the given value.
4331
4332 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
4333 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
4334 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
4335
4336 If the `line-height' property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
4337 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
4338
4339 If the `line-height' value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
4340 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
4341 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
4342 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
4343 exactly that many pixels high.
4344
4345 If the `line-spacing' property value is an positive integer, the value
4346 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
4347 overrides the default frame `line-spacing' and any buffer local value of
4348 the `line-spacing' variable.
4349
4350 If the `line-spacing' property is a float or cons, the line spacing
4351 is calculated as specified above for the `line-height' property.
4352
4353 +++
4354 *** The buffer local `line-spacing' variable can now have a float value,
4355 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
4356
4357 +++
4358 *** Enhancements to stretch display properties
4359
4360 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
4361 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
4362 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
4363
4364 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
4365 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
4366 are supported:
4367
4368 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
4369 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
4370 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
4371 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
4372 | scroll-bar | text
4373 POS ::= left | center | right
4374 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
4375 OP ::= + | -
4376
4377 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
4378 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
4379 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
4380 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
4381 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
4382 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
4383 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
4384 the image.
4385
4386 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
4387 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
4388 corresponding area of the window.
4389
4390 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
4391 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
4392 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
4393 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
4394 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
4395 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
4396 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
4397 the width of the area.
4398
4399 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
4400 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
4401
4402 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
4403 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
4404 header line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
4405
4406 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
4407 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
4408 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
4409 height) of the specified image.
4410
4411 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
4412 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
4413
4414 +++
4415 *** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
4416 text property string that may be present at the current window
4417 position. The cursor can now be placed on any character of such
4418 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
4419
4420 +++
4421 *** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
4422 supported on text terminals.
4423
4424 +++
4425 *** Support for displaying image slices
4426
4427 **** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) can be used with
4428 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
4429
4430 **** Function `insert-image' has new optional fourth arg to
4431 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
4432
4433 **** New function `insert-sliced-image' inserts a given image as a
4434 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
4435
4436 +++
4437 *** Images can now have an associated image map via the :map property.
4438
4439 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
4440 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
4441 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((X0 . Y0) . (X1 . Y1))) specifying the
4442 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
4443 A circle is a cons (circle . ((X0 . Y0) . R)) specifying the center
4444 and the radius of the circle; R can be a float or integer.
4445 A polygon is a cons (poly . [X0 Y0 X1 Y1 ...]) where each pair in the
4446 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
4447
4448 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
4449 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
4450 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
4451 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
4452 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable `void-area-text-pointer'
4453 for possible pointer shapes.
4454
4455 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
4456 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
4457 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
4458
4459 ** Mouse pointer features:
4460
4461 +++ (lispref)
4462 ??? (man)
4463 *** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
4464 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
4465 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
4466 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
4467 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
4468
4469 +++
4470 *** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
4471 :pointer image property.
4472
4473 +++
4474 *** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images can now be
4475 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
4476
4477 ** Mouse event enhancements:
4478
4479 +++
4480 *** Mouse events for clicks on window fringes now specify `left-fringe'
4481 or `right-fringe' as the area.
4482
4483 +++
4484 *** All mouse events now include a buffer position regardless of where
4485 you clicked. For mouse clicks in window margins and fringes, this is
4486 a sensible buffer position corresponding to the surrounding text.
4487
4488 +++
4489 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
4490
4491 +++
4492 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
4493
4494 +++
4495 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
4496 text area).
4497
4498 +++
4499 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types
4500 and all areas.
4501
4502 +++
4503 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns the actual glyph coordinates
4504 of the mouse event position.
4505
4506 +++
4507 *** Mouse events can now indicate an image object clicked on.
4508
4509 +++
4510 *** Mouse events include relative X and Y pixel coordinates relative to
4511 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
4512
4513 +++
4514 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
4515 (image or character) clicked on.
4516
4517 +++
4518 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', 'posn-object-width-height'.
4519
4520 These return the image or string object of a mouse click, the X and Y
4521 pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner of that object, and
4522 the total width and height of that object.
4523
4524 ** Text property and overlay changes:
4525
4526 +++
4527 *** Arguments for `remove-overlays' are now optional, so that you can
4528 remove all overlays in the buffer with just (remove-overlays).
4529
4530 +++
4531 *** New variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4532
4533 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
4534 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
4535 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
4536 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
4537
4538 +++
4539 *** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
4540 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
4541 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
4542 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
4543 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
4544
4545 +++
4546 *** The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties'.
4547
4548 It is like `remove-text-properties' except that it takes a list of
4549 property names as argument rather than a property list.
4550
4551 ** Face changes
4552
4553 +++
4554 *** The new face attribute condition `min-colors' can be used to tailor
4555 the face color to the number of colors supported by a display, and
4556 define the foreground and background colors accordingly so that they
4557 look best on a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This
4558 is now the preferred method for defining default faces in a way that
4559 makes a good use of the capabilities of the display.
4560
4561 +++
4562 *** New function `display-supports-face-attributes-p' can be used to test
4563 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
4564
4565 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
4566 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
4567 defined with `defface'.
4568
4569 ---
4570 *** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4571 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
4572 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4573 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4574 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
4575
4576 +++
4577 *** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
4578 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
4579 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and can be overridden
4580 by them).
4581
4582 +++
4583 *** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
4584 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
4585 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
4586 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
4587 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
4588
4589 ---
4590 *** The function `face-differs-from-default-p' now truly checks
4591 whether the given face displays differently from the default face or
4592 not (previously it did only a very cursory check).
4593
4594 +++
4595 *** `face-attribute', `face-foreground', `face-background', `face-stipple'.
4596
4597 These now accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how
4598 face inheritance is used when determining the value of a face
4599 attribute.
4600
4601 +++
4602 *** New functions `face-attribute-relative-p' and `merge-face-attribute'
4603 help with handling relative face attributes.
4604
4605 +++
4606 *** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face list is reversed.
4607
4608 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
4609 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous
4610 releases of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made
4611 so that :inherit face lists operate identically to face lists in text
4612 `face' properties.
4613
4614 ---
4615 *** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
4616 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
4617
4618 ** Font-Lock changes:
4619
4620 +++
4621 *** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
4622
4623 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
4624 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
4625 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
4626 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
4627
4628 +++
4629 *** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4630
4631 **** the FACENAME returned in `font-lock-keywords' can be a list of the
4632 form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set other
4633 properties than `face'.
4634
4635 **** `font-lock-extra-managed-props' can be set to make sure those
4636 extra properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4637
4638 ---
4639 *** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4640
4641 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4642 (see `jit-lock-defer-contextually'), then all of that text will
4643 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4644 depends on text several lines further down (and when `font-lock-multiline'
4645 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4646
4647 s{
4648 foo
4649 }{
4650 bar
4651 }e
4652
4653 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4654 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a `jit-lock-defer-multiline'
4655 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4656 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4657
4658 ** Major mode mechanism changes:
4659
4660 +++
4661 *** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
4662 precedence over the file name. Likewise an `<?xml' or `<!DOCTYPE'
4663 declaration will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new
4664 var `magic-mode-alist'.
4665
4666 +++
4667 *** Use the new function `run-mode-hooks' to run the major mode's mode hook.
4668
4669 +++
4670 *** All major mode functions should now run the new normal hook
4671 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode
4672 hooks. `run-mode-hooks' does this automatically.
4673
4674 ---
4675 *** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4676 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4677 it in that buffer.
4678
4679 +++
4680 *** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
4681 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
4682 the language.
4683
4684 +++
4685 *** `define-derived-mode' by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4686 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4687
4688 +++
4689 *** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4690 are used by `define-derived-mode' to make sure the mode hook for the
4691 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4692
4693 ** Minor mode changes:
4694
4695 +++
4696 *** `define-minor-mode' now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4697 and simply passes them to `defcustom', if applicable.
4698
4699 +++
4700 *** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
4701
4702 +++
4703 *** `define-global-minor-mode'.
4704
4705 This is a new name for what was formerly called
4706 `easy-mmode-define-global-mode'. The old name remains as an alias.
4707
4708 ** Command loop changes:
4709
4710 +++
4711 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4712 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' to do: it returns t if the
4713 calling function was called through `call-interactively'.
4714
4715 Only use this when you cannot solve the problem by adding a new
4716 INTERACTIVE argument to the command.
4717
4718 +++
4719 *** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional argument.
4720
4721 If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks for a function that could be
4722 called with `call-interactively', and does not return t for keyboard
4723 macros.
4724
4725 +++
4726 *** When a command returns, the command loop moves point out from
4727 within invisible text, in the same way it moves out from within text
4728 covered by an image or composition property.
4729
4730 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4731 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4732 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4733 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4734 `post-command-hook' and thus does not care about intermediate states.
4735
4736 +++
4737 *** If a command sets `transient-mark-mode' to `only', that
4738 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
4739 During that following command, the value of `transient-mark-mode'
4740 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
4741 the next return to the command loop changes to nil.
4742
4743 +++
4744 *** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
4745 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
4746 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
4747
4748 +++
4749 *** `emacsserver' now runs `pre-command-hook' and `post-command-hook'
4750 when it receives a request from emacsclient.
4751
4752 ** Lisp file loading changes:
4753
4754 +++
4755 *** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4756 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4757 current file redefined it).
4758
4759 +++
4760 *** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4761 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
4762
4763 +++
4764 *** The function `symbol-file' can now search specifically for function,
4765 variable or face definitions.
4766
4767 +++
4768 *** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4769 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4770 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4771
4772 ---
4773 *** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4774 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4775 than 3 levels of nesting.
4776
4777 +++
4778 ** Byte compiler changes:
4779
4780 *** The byte compiler now displays the actual line and character
4781 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
4782 warning and error messages have been brought into line with GNU standards
4783 for these. As a result, you can use next-error and friends on the
4784 compilation output buffer.
4785
4786 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
4787 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
4788
4789 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
4790 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
4791 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
4792 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
4793 forms:
4794
4795 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
4796 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
4797
4798 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
4799 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
4800 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
4801 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
4802 macro expansion), but such tests can be nested. Note that `when' and
4803 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
4804
4805 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
4806 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
4807 Emacs and XEmacs and can sometimes make the result significantly more
4808 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
4809 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
4810 you anything.
4811
4812 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in Lisp files is now obeyed.
4813
4814 ---
4815 *** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
4816 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
4817 (require 'cl) when loaded.
4818
4819 ** Frame operations:
4820
4821 +++
4822 *** New functions `frame-current-scroll-bars' and `window-current-scroll-bars'.
4823
4824 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
4825 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
4826
4827 +++
4828 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
4829 for all (existing and future) frames.
4830
4831 +++
4832 *** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4833 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4834 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4835 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4836
4837 +++
4838 *** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
4839 the `scroll-bar-width' frame parameter value is nil.
4840
4841 ** Mule changes:
4842
4843 +++
4844 *** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4845
4846 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4847 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4848 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4849 now:
4850
4851 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4852
4853 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4854 the time it takes to convert the format.
4855
4856 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4857 wasteful.
4858
4859 ---
4860 *** `set-buffer-file-coding-system' now takes an additional argument,
4861 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
4862
4863 +++
4864 *** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
4865 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
4866 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
4867 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
4868
4869 ---
4870 *** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
4871 of one coding system from another coding system.
4872
4873 ---
4874 *** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
4875 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
4876 parts, e.g. utf-16.
4877
4878 +++
4879 *** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
4880 it is read from a file without decoding.
4881
4882 ---
4883 *** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
4884 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
4885
4886 ---
4887 *** New function `quail-find-key' returns a list of keys to type in the
4888 current input method to input a character.
4889
4890 ** Mode line changes:
4891
4892 +++
4893 *** New function `format-mode-line'.
4894
4895 This returns the mode line or header line of the selected (or a
4896 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4897
4898 +++
4899 *** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4900 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4901
4902 +++
4903 *** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4904 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4905 line.
4906
4907 +++
4908 *** Mouse-face on mode-line (and header-line) is now supported.
4909
4910 ** Menu manipulation changes:
4911
4912 ---
4913 *** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
4914 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
4915 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
4916 several versions ago.
4917
4918 ---
4919 *** The dummy function keys made by easy-menu are now always lower case.
4920 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4921 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4922
4923 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
4924 made with easy-menu.
4925
4926 ---
4927 *** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
4928 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
4929 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
4930 need to have a name.
4931
4932 ** Operating system access:
4933
4934 +++
4935 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
4936 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
4937
4938 +++
4939 *** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4940 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4941 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4942
4943 +++
4944 *** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
4945
4946 ---
4947 *** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4948 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4949 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4950
4951 ---
4952 *** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
4953 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
4954
4955 ** Miscellaneous:
4956
4957 +++
4958 *** A number of hooks have been renamed to better follow the conventions:
4959
4960 `find-file-hooks' to `find-file-hook',
4961 `find-file-not-found-hooks' to `find-file-not-found-functions',
4962 `write-file-hooks' to `write-file-functions',
4963 `write-contents-hooks' to `write-contents-functions',
4964 `x-lost-selection-hooks' to `x-lost-selection-functions',
4965 `x-sent-selection-hooks' to `x-sent-selection-functions',
4966 `delete-frame-hook' to `delete-frame-functions'.
4967
4968 In each case the old name remains as an alias for the moment.
4969
4970 +++
4971 *** local-write-file-hooks is marked obsolete
4972
4973 Use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook'.
4974
4975 ---
4976 *** New function `x-send-client-message' sends a client message when
4977 running under X.
4978
4979 ** GC changes:
4980
4981 +++
4982 *** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
4983 on garbage collection.
4984
4985 +++
4986 *** The normal hook `post-gc-hook' is run at the end of garbage collection.
4987
4988 The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4989 \f
4990 * New Packages for Lisp Programming in Emacs 22.1
4991
4992 +++
4993 ** The new library button.el implements simple and fast `clickable
4994 buttons' in emacs buffers. Buttons are much lighter-weight than the
4995 `widgets' implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that
4996 doesn't require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for
4997 such things as help and apropos buffers.
4998
4999 ---
5000 ** The new library tree-widget.el provides a widget to display a set
5001 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
5002 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
5003
5004 ** The new library bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
5005 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
5006 data structures.
5007
5008 ---
5009 ** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
5010 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
5011
5012 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
5013 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
5014 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
5015 commands.
5016
5017 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
5018 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
5019 SQL buffer.
5020
5021 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
5022 (function (lambda ()
5023 (master-mode t)
5024 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5025 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
5026 (function (lambda ()
5027 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
5028
5029 +++
5030 ** The new library benchmark.el does timing measurements on Lisp code.
5031
5032 This includes measuring garbage collection time.
5033
5034 +++
5035 ** The new library testcover.el does test coverage checking.
5036
5037 This is so you can tell whether you've tested all paths in your Lisp
5038 code. It works with edebug.
5039
5040 The function `testcover-start' instruments all functions in a given
5041 file. Then test your code. The function `testcover-mark-all' adds
5042 overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to show where coverage
5043 is lacking. The command `testcover-next-mark' (bind it to a key!)
5044 will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
5045
5046 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
5047 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
5048 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
5049 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
5050 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
5051 value, such as (setq x 14).
5052
5053 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
5054 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5055 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5056 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5057 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5058 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5059 \f
5060 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5061
5062 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5063 been added.
5064
5065 \f
5066 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5067
5068 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5069 with Custom.
5070
5071 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5072 as mule-utf-8.
5073
5074 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5075 in UTF-8 locales).
5076
5077 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5078 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5079 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5080 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5081 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5082 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5083 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5084 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5085 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5086 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5087
5088 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5089 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5090
5091 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5092 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5093 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5094 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5095 contrary to the compound text specification.
5096
5097 \f
5098 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5099
5100 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5101
5102 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5103
5104 \f
5105 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5106
5107 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5108
5109 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5110 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5111 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5112 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5113 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5114
5115 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5116 were changed.
5117
5118 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5119 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5120
5121 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5122 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5123 instead of using default-major-mode.
5124
5125 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5126 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5127 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5128 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5129 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5130 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5131 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5132
5133 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5134 NEWS.
5135
5136 \f
5137 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5138
5139 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5140 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5141 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5142
5143 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5144 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5145
5146 \f
5147 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5148
5149 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5150 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5151 charsets in this release.
5152
5153 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5154
5155 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5156
5157 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5158 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5159 to list them.
5160
5161 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5162 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5163 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5164 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5165 necessary changes to unexec.
5166
5167 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5168 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5169
5170 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5171 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5172
5173 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5174 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5175
5176 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5177 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5178 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5179 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5180 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5181
5182 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5183 new display features described below.
5184
5185 \f
5186 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5187
5188 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5189
5190 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5191 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5192 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5193 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5194 the text.
5195
5196 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5197
5198 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5199 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5200 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5201 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5202 specify a font.
5203
5204 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5205 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5206 under Lisp changes, below.
5207
5208 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5209
5210 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5211 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5212 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5213 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5214 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5215 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5216 on terminals.
5217
5218 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5219 supported on character terminals.
5220
5221 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5222 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5223 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5224 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5225
5226 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5227
5228 ** Sound support
5229
5230 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5231 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5232 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5233 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5234 sound support.
5235
5236 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5237
5238 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5239 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5240 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5241 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5242
5243 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5244
5245 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5246 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5247 specifies a number of lines.
5248
5249 Default is 0.25.
5250
5251 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5252
5253 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5254 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5255 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5256 again.
5257
5258 Default is `grow-only'.
5259
5260 ** LessTif support.
5261
5262 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5263 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5264
5265 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5266
5267 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5268 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5269 non-nil.
5270
5271 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5272
5273 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5274 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5275 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5276
5277 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5278
5279 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5280 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5281 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5282 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5283 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5284 Emacs.
5285
5286 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5287 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5288 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5289 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5290 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5291 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5292
5293 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5294 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5295 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5296 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5297 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5298 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5299
5300 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5301 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5302 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5303 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5304 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5305
5306 ** Tool bar support.
5307
5308 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5309 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5310 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5311 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5312 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5313 icons will be used.
5314
5315 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5316 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5317
5318 ** Tooltips.
5319
5320 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5321 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5322 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5323
5324 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5325 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5326 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5327 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5328
5329 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5330
5331 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5332 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5333 customized.
5334
5335 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5336 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5337 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5338 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5339 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5340
5341 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5342 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5343 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5344 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5345 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5346 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5347
5348 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5349 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5350 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5351 customizing face `fringe'.
5352
5353 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5354 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5355 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5356 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5357 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5358 the window to be partially obscured.)
5359
5360 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5361 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5362 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5363 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5364
5365 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5366
5367 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5368 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5369 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5370 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5371 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5372 have enabled one.
5373
5374 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5375
5376 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5377
5378 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5379
5380 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5381 `*') toggles the status.
5382
5383 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
5384
5385 ** Hourglass pointer
5386
5387 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
5388 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
5389
5390 ** Blinking cursor
5391
5392 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
5393 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
5394 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
5395 the group `cursor'.
5396
5397 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
5398
5399 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
5400 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
5401 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
5402 details.
5403
5404 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
5405 have to do anything to activate it.
5406
5407 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
5408
5409 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
5410 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
5411
5412 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
5413 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
5414 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
5415 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
5416 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
5417 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
5418 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
5419 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
5420
5421 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
5422 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
5423 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
5424 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
5425 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
5426 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
5427
5428 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
5429 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
5430
5431 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
5432 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
5433 buffer by default.
5434
5435 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
5436 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
5437 beginning and end of the buffer.
5438
5439 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
5440 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
5441 signaled.
5442
5443 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
5444 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
5445
5446 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
5447 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
5448 this behavior.
5449
5450 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
5451 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
5452 Emacs dump core.
5453
5454 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
5455
5456 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
5457 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
5458 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
5459
5460 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
5461 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
5462 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
5463
5464 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
5465 using that menu.
5466
5467 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
5468
5469 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
5470 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
5471 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
5472 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
5473 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
5474 whitespace.
5475
5476 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
5477 all frames except the selected one.
5478
5479 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5480 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5481
5482 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5483 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5484 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5485 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5486 `Info-use-header-line'.
5487
5488 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5489 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5490 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5491
5492 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5493
5494 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5495 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5496 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5497
5498 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5499 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5500 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5501 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5502
5503 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5504
5505 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5506 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5507 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5508 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5509
5510 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5511 point in a pop-up window.
5512
5513 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5514 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5515 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5516
5517 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5518 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5519
5520 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5521 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5522 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5523 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5524
5525 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5526
5527 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5528 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5529
5530 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5531 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5532 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5533
5534 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5535 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5536 non-nil.
5537
5538 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5539 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5540 file that is already visited under a different name.
5541
5542 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5543 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5544
5545 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5546 and displays information about that.
5547
5548 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5549 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5550
5551 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5552 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5553 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5554 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5555 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5556 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5557
5558 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5559 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5560
5561 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5562 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5563 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5564 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5565 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5566 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5567 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5568
5569 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5570 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5571
5572 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5573 system for keyboard input.
5574
5575 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5576 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5577 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5578 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5579 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5580 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5581 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5582 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5583 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5584
5585 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5586 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5587
5588 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5589 displays all characters in that character set.
5590
5591 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5592 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5593
5594 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5595 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5596 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5597
5598 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5599 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5600 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5601 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5602 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5603 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5604 and Polish `slash'.
5605
5606 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5607 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5608 of the tutorial.
5609
5610 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5611 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5612 Lisp Coding Convention".
5613
5614 new command old-binding
5615 --- ------- -----------
5616 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5617 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5618 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5619
5620 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5621 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5622 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5623
5624 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5625 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5626 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5627 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5628 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5629 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5630
5631 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5632 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5633 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5634 package.
5635
5636 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5637 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5638 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5639 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5640 "`", you must type "=q".
5641
5642 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5643 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5644 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5645 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5646 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5647 on.
5648
5649 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5650 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5651 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5652 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5653
5654 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5655 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5656 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5657 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5658
5659 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5660 on the display using several methods
5661
5662 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5663 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5664 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5665
5666 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5667 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5668
5669 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5670
5671 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5672 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5673
5674 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5675 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5676 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5677 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5678
5679 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5680 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5681 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5682
5683 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5684 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5685
5686 ** New X resources recognized
5687
5688 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5689 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5690 is useful for debugging X problems.
5691
5692 Example:
5693
5694 emacs.synchronous: true
5695
5696 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5697 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5698 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5699 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5700 visual class names are
5701
5702 TrueColor
5703 PseudoColor
5704 DirectColor
5705 StaticColor
5706 GrayScale
5707 StaticGray
5708
5709 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5710 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5711 meaning.
5712
5713 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5714 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5715 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5716 visual.
5717
5718 Example:
5719
5720 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5721
5722 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5723 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5724 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5725 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5726
5727 Example:
5728
5729 emacs.privateColormap: true
5730
5731 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5732
5733 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5734 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5735 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5736 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5737 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5738 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5739 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5740
5741 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5742 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5743 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5744 `default' face and vice versa.
5745
5746 ** New face `menu'.
5747
5748 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5749
5750 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5751
5752 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5753 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5754 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5755 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5756
5757 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5758 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5759 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5760
5761 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5762 `ScreenGamma'.
5763
5764 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5765
5766 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5767 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5768 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5769 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5770
5771 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5772
5773 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5774
5775 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5776
5777 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5778 LessTif/Motif one.
5779
5780 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5781 LessTif and Motif.
5782
5783 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5784
5785 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5786 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5787 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5788
5789 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5790 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5791
5792 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5793 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5794 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5795
5796 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5797
5798 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5799 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5800 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5801 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5802
5803 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5804 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5805 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5806 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5807
5808 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5809 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5810 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5811 buffers.
5812
5813 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5814
5815 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5816 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5817 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5818
5819 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5820 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5821 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5822 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5823 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5824 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5825
5826 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5827
5828 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5829 notably at the end of lines.
5830
5831 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5832 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5833
5834 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5835
5836 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5837 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5838
5839 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5840 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5841 after each match to get the replacement text.
5842
5843 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5844 you edit the replacement string.
5845
5846 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5847 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5848 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5849
5850 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5851
5852 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5853 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5854
5855 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5856 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5857 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5858 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5859
5860 --
5861 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5862 read mail from the menu etc.
5863
5864 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5865 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5866 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5867 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5868
5869 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5870 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5871
5872 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5873 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5874 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5875 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5876 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5877 of Emacs.
5878
5879 ** Customize changes
5880
5881 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5882 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5883 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5884 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5885 earlier versions of Emacs.
5886
5887 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5888 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5889 default).
5890
5891 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5892 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5893 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5894 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5895 file.
5896
5897 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5898 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5899 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5900 already in your init file.
5901
5902 ** New features in evaluation commands
5903
5904 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5905 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5906 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5907 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5908 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5909
5910 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5911 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5912 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5913 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5914 printed).
5915
5916 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5917 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5918
5919 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5920 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5921
5922 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5923 code when called with a prefix argument.
5924
5925 ** CC mode changes.
5926
5927 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5928 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5929 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5930 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5931 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5932 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5933 release.
5934
5935 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5936 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5937 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5938 confusion.
5939
5940 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5941 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5942 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5943 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5944
5945 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5946 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5947
5948 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5949 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5950
5951 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5952 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5953 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5954 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5955
5956 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5957 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5958 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5959 earlier statement. An example:
5960
5961 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5962 if (a[i])
5963 res += a[i]->offset;
5964 else
5965
5966 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5967 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5968 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5969 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5970 the preceding "if".
5971
5972 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5973 by default.
5974
5975 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5976 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5977 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5978 documentation or other natural language text.
5979
5980 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5981 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5982 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5983 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5984 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5985 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5986 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5987
5988 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5989 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5990 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5991 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5992
5993 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5994 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5995 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5996 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5997 Pike mode only.
5998
5999 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6000 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6001 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6002 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6003 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6004 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6005 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6006 is reported afterwards.
6007
6008 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6009 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6010 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6011
6012 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6013 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6014 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6015 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6016 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6017 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6018 groundwork.
6019
6020 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6021 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6022 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6023 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6024 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6025 have to bother.
6026
6027 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6028 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6029 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6030 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6031 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6032 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6033
6034 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6035 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6036 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6037 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6038 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6039 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6040 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6041 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6042
6043 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6044 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6045 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6046 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6047 above.
6048
6049 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6050 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6051 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6052 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6053 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6054 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6055 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6056 function documentation for more info.
6057
6058 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6059 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6060 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6061 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6062 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6063 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6064 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6065 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6066
6067 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6068
6069 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6070 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6071
6072 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6073 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6074 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6075 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6076 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6077 style system.
6078
6079 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6080 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6081 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6082 as far as possible.
6083
6084 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6085 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6086 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6087 chapter about this in the manual.
6088
6089 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6090 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6091 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6092 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6093 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6094
6095 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6096 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6097 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6098
6099 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6100 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6101
6102 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6103 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6104 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6105 inside CC Mode.
6106
6107 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6108 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6109 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6110 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6111 cc-mode/).
6112
6113 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6114 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6115 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6116 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6117 they were before the filling.
6118
6119 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6120 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6121 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6122 literals.
6123
6124 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6125 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6126 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6127 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6128 this function.
6129
6130 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6131 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6132 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6133 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6134 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6135
6136 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6137 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6138 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6139
6140 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6141
6142 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6143 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6144 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6145 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6146
6147 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6148 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6149 the column specified by comment-column.
6150
6151 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6152 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6153 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6154 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6155 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6156 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6157
6158 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6159 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6160 arguments.
6161
6162 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6163
6164 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6165 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6166 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6167 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6168 Provan).
6169
6170 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6171
6172 ** Dired changes
6173
6174 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6175 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6176 is, delete only empty directories.
6177
6178 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6179 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6180 copy directories recursively.
6181
6182 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6183 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6184 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6185
6186 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6187 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6188 directory.
6189
6190 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6191 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6192 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6193 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6194 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6195
6196 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6197 from ls switches.
6198
6199 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6200 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6201 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6202 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6203
6204 ** Gnus changes.
6205
6206 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6207 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6208 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6209
6210 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6211 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6212
6213 If you used procmail like in
6214
6215 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6216 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6217 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6218 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6219
6220 this now has changed to
6221
6222 (setq mail-sources
6223 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6224 :suffix ".in")))
6225
6226 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6227 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6228
6229 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6230 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6231 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6232 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6233
6234 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6235 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6236 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6237
6238 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6239 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6240 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6241 now just a compatibility layer.
6242
6243 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6244 Gnus facilities.
6245
6246 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6247 called to position point.
6248
6249 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6250 summary buffers and NOV files.
6251
6252 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6253 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6254
6255 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6256 subtly different manner.
6257
6258 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6259 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6260 ever-changing layouts.
6261
6262 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6263
6264 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6265
6266 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6267
6268 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6269 macros
6270
6271 Key binding Macro
6272 -------------------------
6273 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6274 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6275 C-c C-c u @uref
6276 C-c C-c q @quotation
6277 C-c C-c m @email
6278 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6279 M-RET @item
6280
6281 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6282
6283 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6284
6285 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6286 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6287 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6288
6289 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6290
6291 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6292 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6293 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6294 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6295 buffers to kill, as before.
6296
6297 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6298 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6299 this way.
6300
6301 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6302 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6303
6304 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6305
6306 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6307 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6308 use. Default is 1000.
6309
6310 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6311 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6312
6313 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6314
6315 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6316
6317 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6318 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6319 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6320 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6321
6322 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6323 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6324 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6325 the open block.
6326
6327 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6328 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6329 the normal block-hiding function.
6330
6331 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6332
6333 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6334 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6335 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6336 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6337
6338 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6339 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6340
6341 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6342
6343 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6344 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6345 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6346
6347 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6348 current buffer.
6349
6350 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6351 in a log file.
6352
6353 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6354 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6355 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6356 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6357 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6358 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6359
6360 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6361
6362 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6363
6364 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6365 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6366
6367 ** Changes in Font Lock
6368
6369 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6370 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6371
6372 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6373 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6374
6375 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6376 the face used for each string/comment.
6377
6378 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6379 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6380
6381 ** Changes to Shell mode
6382
6383 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
6384 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
6385 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
6386 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
6387
6388 ** Comint (subshell) changes
6389
6390 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
6391 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
6392
6393 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
6394 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
6395 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
6396 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
6397 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
6398 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
6399
6400 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
6401 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
6402 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
6403 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
6404 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
6405 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
6406 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
6407 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
6408
6409 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
6410 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
6411
6412 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
6413 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
6414 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
6415
6416 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
6417 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
6418 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
6419
6420 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
6421 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
6422 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
6423
6424 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
6425 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
6426 argument, it appends to the file.
6427
6428 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
6429 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
6430 compatibility.
6431
6432 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
6433 ring (history).
6434
6435 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
6436 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
6437 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
6438
6439 ** Changes to Rmail mode
6440
6441 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
6442 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
6443 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
6444 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
6445 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
6446 as correspondent.
6447
6448 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
6449 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
6450 regexp matching your mail addresses.
6451
6452 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
6453 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
6454 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
6455 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
6456 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
6457
6458 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
6459 like `j'.
6460
6461 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
6462 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
6463 digest message.
6464
6465 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
6466 in which folder to put messages automatically.
6467
6468 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
6469 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
6470 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
6471
6472 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
6473 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
6474
6475 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
6476 use the -f option when sending mail.
6477
6478 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6479 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6480 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6481 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6482 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6483 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6484
6485 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6486 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6487 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6488
6489 ** Changes to TeX mode
6490
6491 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6492 `latex-mode'.
6493
6494 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6495
6496 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6497
6498 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6499
6500 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6501
6502 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6503 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6504 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6505 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6506 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6507 can be edited from that buffer.
6508
6509 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6510 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6511 `A' to use all marked entries).
6512
6513 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6514 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6515
6516 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6517 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6518 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6519 been cited.
6520
6521 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6522 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6523 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6524 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6525
6526 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6527 has the following new features:
6528
6529 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6530 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6531 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6532 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6533
6534 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6535 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6536 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6537 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6538 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6539 defaults to 1.
6540
6541 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6542 file names.
6543
6544 ** Ispell changes
6545
6546 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6547 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6548 spell-checks the current buffer.
6549
6550 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6551 added.
6552
6553 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6554 correction is made and re-checked.
6555
6556 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6557
6558 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6559 cases.
6560
6561 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6562 on syntax errors.
6563
6564 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6565 end of the buffer.
6566
6567 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6568
6569 ** Makefile mode changes
6570
6571 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6572
6573 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6574 Fontlock mode is active.
6575
6576 ** Isearch changes
6577
6578 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6579 so that searches can be resumed.
6580
6581 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6582 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6583 that started the search.
6584
6585 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6586 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6587
6588 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6589
6590 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6591 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6592 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6593 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6594 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6595 `secondary-selection'.
6596
6597 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6598 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6599 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6600 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6601 usual snappy response.
6602
6603 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6604 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6605 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6606 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6607
6608 ** VC Changes
6609
6610 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6611 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6612 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6613 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6614 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6615 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6616 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6617 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6618 file is registered in that backend.
6619
6620 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6621 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6622 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6623 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6624 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6625 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6626
6627 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6628 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6629 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6630 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6631 where it doesn't make sense.)
6632
6633 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6634 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6635 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6636
6637 *** General Changes
6638
6639 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6640 checks are always done now.
6641
6642 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6643 operations.
6644
6645 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6646 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6647 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6648
6649 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6650 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6651 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6652 the working file (``merge news'').
6653
6654 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6655 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6656 downwards.
6657
6658 *** Multiple Backends
6659
6660 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6661 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6662 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6663 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6664 local RCS archives.
6665
6666 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6667 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6668 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6669 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6670
6671 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6672 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6673 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6674 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6675 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6676
6677 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6678 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6679 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6680 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6681
6682 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6683 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6684 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6685 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6686
6687 *** Changes for CVS
6688
6689 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6690 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6691 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6692 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6693 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6694 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6695 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6696
6697 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6698 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6699 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6700 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6701 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6702 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6703 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6704 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6705 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6706 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6707 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6708 name.)
6709
6710 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6711 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6712 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6713 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6714 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6715 entire directory tree.
6716
6717 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6718 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6719 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6720 "watched" by other developers.)
6721
6722 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6723 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6724 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6725 starting at the given directory.
6726
6727 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6728
6729 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6730 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6731 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6732 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6733 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6734 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6735 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6736 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6737 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6738
6739 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6740 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6741 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6742 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6743
6744 ** New modes and packages
6745
6746 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6747 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6748 the default is not applicable.
6749
6750 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6751 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6752 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6753
6754 Features are:
6755
6756 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6757 drawn, like this: | \ /
6758 --+-- X
6759 | / \
6760
6761 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6762 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6763 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6764 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6765 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6766 you are drawing.
6767
6768 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6769 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6770
6771 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6772 flood-filling.
6773
6774 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6775 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6776 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6777 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6778
6779 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6780 also do without the mouse.
6781
6782 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6783 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6784 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6785 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6786 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6787
6788 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6789
6790 lines straight-lines
6791 rectangles squares
6792 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6793 ellipses circles
6794 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6795 spray-can setting size for spraying
6796 vaporize line vaporize lines
6797 erase characters erase rectangles
6798
6799 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6800 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6801 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6802 drawing.
6803
6804 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6805 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6806 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6807 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6808
6809 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6810 can be turned off).
6811
6812 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6813 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6814 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6815 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6816 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6817 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6818 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6819 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6820 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6821
6822 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6823 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6824 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6825 on certain projects.
6826
6827 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6828 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6829
6830 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6831
6832 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6833 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6834 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6835 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6836 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6837 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6838 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6839 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6840
6841 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6842 Emacs is idle.
6843
6844 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6845 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6846
6847 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6848 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6849
6850 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6851 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6852 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6853 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6854 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6855
6856 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6857 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6858 separate Texinfo file.
6859
6860 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6861 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6862 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6863 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6864 enter check-in log messages.
6865
6866 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6867 without invoking external programs.
6868
6869 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6870 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6871 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6872 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6873 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6874
6875 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6876 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6877
6878 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6879 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6880
6881 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6882 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6883 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6884 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6885 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6886 single step.
6887
6888 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6889 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6890 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6891 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6892
6893 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6894 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6895 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6896
6897 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6898 PostScript.
6899
6900 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6901
6902 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6903
6904 ; comment (until end of line)
6905 A non-terminal
6906 "C" terminal
6907 ?C? special
6908 $A default non-terminal
6909 $"C" default terminal
6910 $?C? default special
6911 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6912 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6913 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6914 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6915 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6916 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6917 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6918 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6919 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6920 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6921 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6922 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6923 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6924 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6925 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6926
6927 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6928
6929 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6930 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6931 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6932 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6933 equal signs of assignments.
6934
6935 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6936 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6937
6938 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6939 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6940 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6941
6942 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6943
6944 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6945 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6946 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6947 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6948 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6949 which answers different needs.
6950
6951 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6952 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6953 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6954 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6955 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6956 to be enabled.
6957
6958 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6959 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6960
6961 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6962
6963 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6964 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6965 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6966
6967 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6968
6969 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6970 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6971 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6972 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6973 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6974 and background colors.
6975
6976 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6977 Pascal) language.
6978
6979 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6980 the text at point.
6981
6982 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6983
6984 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6985
6986 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6987 whitespace in a file.
6988
6989 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6990 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6991 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6992 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6993 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6994 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6995 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6996
6997 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6998
6999 Here is an example of columns:
7000
7001 horse apple bus
7002 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7003 porcupine strawberry airplane
7004
7005 Doing the following settings:
7006
7007 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7008 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7009 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7010 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7011
7012
7013 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7014
7015 M-x delimit-columns-region
7016
7017 It results:
7018
7019 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7020 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7021 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7022
7023 delim-col has the following options:
7024
7025 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7026 before all columns.
7027
7028 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7029 between each column.
7030
7031 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7032 after all columns.
7033
7034 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7035 each column.
7036
7037 delim-col has the following commands:
7038
7039 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7040 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7041
7042 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7043 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7044 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7045 recent file list can be displayed:
7046
7047 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7048 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7049 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7050
7051 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7052 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7053
7054 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7055 text.
7056
7057 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7058 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7059 specific to Message mode.
7060
7061 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7062 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7063 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7064
7065 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7066 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7067 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7068
7069 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7070 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7071
7072 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7073
7074 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7075 minibuffer with completion.
7076
7077 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7078 with the diary features.
7079
7080 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7081 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7082
7083 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7084 Fill mode.
7085
7086 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7087 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7088 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7089 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7090
7091 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7092 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7093 `.g'.
7094
7095 ** Changes in sort.el
7096
7097 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7098 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7099 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7100 numeric base.
7101
7102 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7103
7104 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7105 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7106 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7107
7108 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7109 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7110
7111 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7112 output ^M at the end of lines.
7113
7114 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7115 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7116
7117 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7118 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7119 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7120
7121 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7122 group.
7123
7124 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7125 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7126 are recognized:
7127
7128 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7129 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7130 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7131 nil -- just delete one character.
7132
7133 Default value is `untabify'.
7134
7135 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7136
7137 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7138 symbol, not double-quoted.
7139
7140 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7141 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7142 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7143 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7144
7145 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7146 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7147 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7148
7149 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7150 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7151 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7152
7153 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7154 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7155
7156 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7157 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7158
7159 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7160 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7161
7162 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7163 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7164 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7165 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7166 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7167 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7168
7169 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7170 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7171
7172 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7173
7174 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7175 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7176
7177 ** Shell script mode changes.
7178
7179 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7180 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7181 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7182
7183 ** Etags changes.
7184
7185 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7186
7187 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7188 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7189 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7190 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7191 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7192
7193 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7194 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7195
7196 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7197 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7198
7199 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7200 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7201 `template' keywords.
7202
7203 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7204 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7205
7206 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7207 types.
7208
7209 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7210
7211 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7212
7213 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7214 are now tagged.
7215
7216 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7217
7218 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7219 variables are tagged.
7220
7221 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7222
7223 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7224 for PSWrap.
7225
7226 ** Changes in etags.el
7227
7228 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7229 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7230 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7231
7232 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7233 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7234
7235 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7236 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7237 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7238 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7239
7240 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7241
7242 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7243 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7244
7245 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7246
7247 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7248 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7249 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7250
7251 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7252 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7253
7254 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7255 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7256
7257 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7258 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7259 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7260 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7261 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7262
7263 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7264 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7265 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7266
7267 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7268 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7269 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7270
7271 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7272 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7273 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7274
7275 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7276
7277 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7278
7279 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7280 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7281 expression from that list, are not checked.
7282
7283 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7284 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7285 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7286 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7287
7288 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7289
7290 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7291 displays local abbrevs, only.
7292
7293 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7294 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7295
7296 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7297 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7298 is measured in pixels.
7299
7300 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7301 to be visited as images.
7302
7303 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7304 were added to compile.el.
7305
7306 ** Withdrawn packages
7307
7308 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7309 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7310
7311 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7312
7313 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7314
7315 \f
7316 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7317
7318 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7319 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7320 See the sections below for details.
7321
7322 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7323 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7324 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7325 to remove the properties of the copy.
7326
7327 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7328 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7329 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7330 these properties are active.
7331
7332 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7333 ranges may affect some code.
7334
7335 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7336 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7337 make a difference to some code.
7338
7339 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7340 operates on the minibuffer.
7341
7342 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7343 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7344 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7345 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7346 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7347 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7348 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7349 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7350 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7351 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7352 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7353 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7354
7355 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7356 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7357 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7358
7359 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7360 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7361 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7362
7363 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7364 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7365 such as `mapconcat'.
7366
7367 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7368 string.
7369
7370 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7371 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7372 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7373 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7374 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7375 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7376 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7377 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7378
7379 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7380 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7381 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
7382 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
7383 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
7384 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
7385 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
7386 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
7387 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
7388 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7389
7390 \f
7391 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
7392 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
7393
7394 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
7395
7396 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
7397 allows the animated display of strings.
7398
7399 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
7400 interactive form of a function.
7401
7402 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
7403 between custom options. Example:
7404
7405 (defcustom default-input-method nil
7406 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
7407 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
7408 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
7409 :group 'mule
7410 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
7411 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
7412
7413 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
7414 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
7415 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
7416
7417 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
7418 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
7419 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
7420 (signal or normal termination).
7421
7422 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
7423 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
7424
7425 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
7426 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
7427
7428 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
7429 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
7430
7431 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
7432
7433 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
7434 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
7435 being deleted.
7436
7437 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
7438
7439 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
7440 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
7441 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
7442 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
7443 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
7444 charset.
7445
7446 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
7447 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
7448 message.
7449
7450 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
7451 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
7452
7453 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
7454 with the more general `:mask' property.
7455
7456 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
7457
7458 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
7459 backslash.
7460
7461 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
7462 is running in batch mode. For example,
7463
7464 (message "%s" (read t))
7465
7466 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
7467 to standard output.
7468
7469 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
7470 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
7471
7472 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
7473 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
7474 frame or window.
7475
7476 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
7477 were added
7478
7479 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7480
7481 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7482 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7483
7484 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7485
7486 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7487 comparison is done with `eq'.
7488
7489 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7490
7491 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7492 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7493 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7494
7495 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7496 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7497 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7498
7499 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7500 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7501
7502 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7503 function was declared obsolete.
7504
7505 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7506 retained as an alias).
7507
7508 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7509 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7510
7511 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7512
7513 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7514
7515 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7516 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7517 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7518 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7519 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7520 means never include the minibuffer window.
7521
7522 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7523
7524 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7525
7526 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7527
7528 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7529 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7530 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7531 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7532 returned.
7533
7534 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7535 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7536 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7537 minibuffer even if it is active.
7538
7539 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7540 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7541 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7542 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7543 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7544 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7545
7546 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7547 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7548 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7549 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7550 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7551 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7552 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7553
7554 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7555 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7556 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7557
7558 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7559 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7560 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7561 Default value is nil.
7562
7563 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7564 meaning no limit.
7565
7566 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7567 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7568 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7569
7570 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7571 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7572 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7573
7574 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7575 list of a primitive.
7576
7577 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7578
7579 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7580 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7581 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7582 than replacing the local map.
7583
7584 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7585 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7586 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7587 instead.
7588
7589 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7590
7591 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7592 as promised long ago.
7593
7594 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7595
7596 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7597 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7598 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7599
7600 \f
7601 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7602
7603 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7604 regular expressions.
7605
7606 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7607
7608 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7609
7610 - Macro: rx SEXP
7611
7612 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7613
7614 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7615 notation.
7616
7617 STRING
7618 matches string STRING literally.
7619
7620 CHAR
7621 matches character CHAR literally.
7622
7623 `not-newline'
7624 matches any character except a newline.
7625 .
7626 `anything'
7627 matches any character
7628
7629 `(any SET)'
7630 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7631 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7632
7633 '(in SET)'
7634 like `any'.
7635
7636 `(not (any SET))'
7637 matches any character not in SET
7638
7639 `line-start'
7640 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7641 in the text being matched
7642
7643 `line-end'
7644 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7645
7646 `string-start'
7647 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7648 string being matched against.
7649
7650 `string-end'
7651 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7652 string being matched against.
7653
7654 `buffer-start'
7655 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7656 buffer being matched against.
7657
7658 `buffer-end'
7659 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7660 buffer being matched against.
7661
7662 `point'
7663 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7664
7665 `word-start'
7666 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7667 word.
7668
7669 `word-end'
7670 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7671
7672 `word-boundary'
7673 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7674 word.
7675
7676 `(not word-boundary)'
7677 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7678 word.
7679
7680 `digit'
7681 matches 0 through 9.
7682
7683 `control'
7684 matches ASCII control characters.
7685
7686 `hex-digit'
7687 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7688
7689 `blank'
7690 matches space and tab only.
7691
7692 `graphic'
7693 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7694 space, and DEL.
7695
7696 `printing'
7697 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7698 and DEL.
7699
7700 `alphanumeric'
7701 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7702 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7703
7704 `letter'
7705 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7706 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7707
7708 `ascii'
7709 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7710
7711 `nonascii'
7712 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7713
7714 `lower'
7715 matches anything lower-case.
7716
7717 `upper'
7718 matches anything upper-case.
7719
7720 `punctuation'
7721 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7722 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7723
7724 `space'
7725 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7726
7727 `word'
7728 matches anything that has word syntax.
7729
7730 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7731 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7732 of the following symbols.
7733
7734 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7735 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7736 `word' (\\sw)
7737 `symbol' (\\s_)
7738 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7739 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7740 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7741 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7742 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7743 `escape' (\\s\\)
7744 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7745 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7746 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7747
7748 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7749 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7750
7751 `(category CATEGORY)'
7752 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7753 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7754
7755 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7756 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7757 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7758 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7759 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7760 `symbol' (\\c5)
7761 `digit' (\\c6)
7762 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7763 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7764 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7765 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7766 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7767 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7768 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7769 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7770 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7771 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7772 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7773 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7774 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7775 `ascii' (\\ca)
7776 `arabic' (\\cb)
7777 `chinese' (\\cc)
7778 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7779 `greek' (\\cg)
7780 `korean' (\\ch)
7781 `indian' (\\ci)
7782 `japanese' (\\cj)
7783 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7784 `latin' (\\cl)
7785 `lao' (\\co)
7786 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7787 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7788 `thai' (\\ct)
7789 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7790 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7791 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7792 `can-break' (\\c|)
7793
7794 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7795 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7796
7797 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7798 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7799
7800 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7801 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7802 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7803
7804 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7805 another name for `submatch'.
7806
7807 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7808 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7809 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7810 regular expression.
7811
7812 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7813 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7814 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7815 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7816 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7817
7818 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7819 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7820
7821 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7822 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7823
7824 `(0+ SEXP)'
7825 like `zero-or-more'.
7826
7827 `(* SEXP)'
7828 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7829
7830 `(*? SEXP)'
7831 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7832
7833 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7834 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7835
7836 `(1+ SEXP)'
7837 like `one-or-more'.
7838
7839 `(+ SEXP)'
7840 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7841
7842 `(+? SEXP)'
7843 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7844
7845 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7846 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7847
7848 `(optional SEXP)'
7849 like `zero-or-one'.
7850
7851 `(? SEXP)'
7852 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7853
7854 `(?? SEXP)'
7855 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7856
7857 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7858 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7859
7860 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7861 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7862
7863 `(eval FORM)'
7864 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7865 `regexp-quote' it.
7866
7867 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7868 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7869
7870 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7871
7872 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7873 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7874 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7875 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7876
7877 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7878 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7879 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7880 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7881
7882 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7883 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7884 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7885
7886 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7887 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7888 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7889 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7890 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7891 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7892 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7893 eight-bit-graphic.
7894
7895 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7896
7897 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7898 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7899 character set as previously.
7900
7901 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7902 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7903 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7904
7905 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7906 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7907 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7908 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7909
7910 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7911 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7912
7913 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7914 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7915 "fontset-default".
7916
7917 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7918 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7919
7920 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7921 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7922 buffers and strings.
7923
7924 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7925 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7926 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7927 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7928 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7929 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7930 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7931 also been deleted.
7932
7933 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7934 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7935 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7936
7937 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7938 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7939 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7940 may differ between buffer and string text.
7941
7942 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7943 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7944
7945 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7946 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7947 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7948 `composition' from STRING.
7949
7950 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7951 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7952
7953 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7954 obsolete.
7955
7956 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7957 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7958
7959 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7960 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7961 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7962 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7963
7964 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7965 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7966 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7967 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7968 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7969 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7970
7971 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7972 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7973 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7974
7975 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7976 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7977 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7978
7979 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7980 have been introduced.
7981
7982 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7983 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7984 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7985 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7986 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
7987 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7988 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7989 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7990 their multibyte equivalent.
7991
7992 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7993 that offset in the file before writing.
7994
7995 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7996 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7997
7998 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7999 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8000 from which the command was issued.
8001
8002 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8003 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8004 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8005 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8006 operate on.
8007
8008 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8009 to `window-buffer-height'.
8010
8011 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8012
8013 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8014 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8015 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8016
8017 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8018 respectively.
8019
8020 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8021 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8022
8023 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8024 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8025 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8026
8027 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8028 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8029 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8030 is currently displayed in some window.
8031
8032 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8033 argument function's results.
8034
8035 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8036 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8037 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8038 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8039 sequence).
8040
8041 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8042 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8043
8044 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8045 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8046
8047 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8048 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8049 as follows:
8050
8051 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8052 nil don't display a cursor
8053 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8054 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8055 others display a box cursor.
8056
8057 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8058 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8059 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8060 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8061
8062 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8063 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8064 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8065 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8066
8067 Example:
8068
8069 (string-to-syntax "()")
8070 => (4 . 41)
8071
8072 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8073 other than 10.
8074
8075 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8076 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8077
8078 #b1111
8079 => 15
8080 #b-1111
8081 => -15
8082
8083 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8084
8085 #o666
8086 => 438
8087
8088 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8089
8090 #xbeef
8091 => 48815
8092
8093 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8094
8095 #2R-111
8096 => -7
8097 #25rah
8098 => 267
8099
8100 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8101 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8102 and isn't a string.
8103
8104 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8105 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8106 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8107 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8108
8109 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8110
8111 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8112 for a regexp in a string.
8113
8114 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8115 `mouse-position-function'.
8116
8117 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8118 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8119
8120 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8121 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8122
8123 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8124 returns it.
8125
8126 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8127 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8128
8129 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8130 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8131 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8132 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8133 mode.
8134
8135 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8136 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8137
8138 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8139 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8140 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8141 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8142 been performed."
8143
8144 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8145 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8146 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8147 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8148
8149 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8150 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8151 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8152
8153 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8154 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8155 specified table.
8156
8157 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8158
8159 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8160 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8161 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8162 what BODY returns.
8163
8164 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8165 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8166 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8167 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8168 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8169
8170 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8171 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8172
8173 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8174 instead of being optional.
8175
8176 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8177 modify read-only text.
8178
8179 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8180
8181 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8182 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8183 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8184 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8185 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8186
8187 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8188 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8189 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8190 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8191 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8192 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8193 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8194
8195 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8196 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8197 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8198 start sequences.
8199
8200 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8201 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8202
8203 ** New function `propertize'
8204
8205 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8206 strings with text properties.
8207
8208 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8209
8210 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8211 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8212 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8213 specified value of that property. Example:
8214
8215 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8216
8217 ** push and pop macros.
8218
8219 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8220 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8221 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8222
8223 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8224 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8225 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8226
8227 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8228
8229 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8230 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8231
8232 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8233 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8234 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8235 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8236
8237 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8238 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8239 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8240 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8241
8242 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8243 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8244 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8245 or a sign.
8246
8247 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8248 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8249 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8250 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8251 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8252 space, and DEL.
8253 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8254 and DEL.
8255 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8256 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8257 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8258 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8259 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8260 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8261 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8262 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8263 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8264 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8265 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8266 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8267 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8268 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8269 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8270
8271 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8272
8273 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8274
8275 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8276
8277 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8278 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8279
8280 :test TEST
8281
8282 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8283 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8284 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8285
8286 :size SIZE
8287
8288 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8289 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8290
8291 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8292
8293 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8294 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8295 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8296 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8297 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8298
8299 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8300
8301 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8302 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8303 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8304
8305 :weakness WEAK
8306
8307 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8308 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8309 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8310 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8311 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8312
8313 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8314
8315 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8316
8317 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8318
8319 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8320
8321 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8322
8323 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8324 values are shared.
8325
8326 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8327
8328 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8329
8330 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8331
8332 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8333
8334 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8335
8336 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8337
8338 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8339
8340 Returns the size of TABLE.
8341
8342 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8343
8344 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8345
8346 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8347
8348 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8349
8350 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8351
8352 Clear TABLE.
8353
8354 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8355
8356 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8357 not found.
8358
8359 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8360
8361 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8362 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8363
8364 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8365
8366 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8367
8368 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8369
8370 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8371 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8372
8373 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8374
8375 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8376
8377 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8378
8379 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8380 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8381 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
8382 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
8383 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
8384
8385 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
8386
8387 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
8388 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
8389 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
8390
8391 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
8392 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
8393
8394 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
8395 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
8396
8397 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
8398 (sxhash (upcase a)))
8399
8400 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
8401 'case-fold-string-hash))
8402
8403 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
8404
8405 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
8406
8407 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
8408 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
8409 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
8410
8411 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
8412
8413 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
8414 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
8415
8416 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
8417 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
8418 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
8419 is too short to reach that column.
8420
8421 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
8422 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
8423 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
8424 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
8425
8426 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
8427 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
8428 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
8429
8430 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
8431 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
8432
8433 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
8434 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
8435
8436 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
8437 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
8438 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
8439 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
8440 temporary-file-directory instead.
8441
8442 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
8443 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
8444 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
8445 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
8446
8447 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
8448 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
8449
8450 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
8451
8452 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
8453 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
8454 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
8455
8456 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
8457
8458 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
8459 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
8460 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
8461 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
8462 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
8463 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
8464
8465 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
8466 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
8467 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
8468 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
8469
8470 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
8471
8472 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
8473 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
8474 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
8475 result string.
8476
8477 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
8478 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8479
8480 Example:
8481
8482 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8483 (s2 "world"))
8484 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8485 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8486 (format s1 s2))
8487
8488 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8489
8490 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8491
8492 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8493 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8494 argument in it.
8495
8496 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8497 (arg "world"))
8498 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8499 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8500 (message msg arg))
8501
8502 ** Sound support
8503
8504 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8505 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8506
8507 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8508 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8509 to enable sound support.
8510
8511 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8512 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8513 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8514 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8515 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8516
8517 The following sound properties are supported:
8518
8519 - `:file FILE'
8520
8521 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8522 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8523
8524 - `:data DATA'
8525
8526 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8527 may be present, but not both.
8528
8529 - `:volume VOLUME'
8530
8531 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8532 0..1. This property is optional.
8533
8534 - `:device DEVICE'
8535
8536 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8537 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8538
8539 Other properties are ignored.
8540
8541 An alternative interface is called as
8542 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8543
8544 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8545
8546 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8547 a keyword symbol.
8548
8549 ** Changes to garbage collection
8550
8551 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8552 of live and free strings.
8553
8554 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8555 strings that have been consed so far.
8556
8557 \f
8558 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8559 Lisp Manual
8560
8561 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8562 mini-windows.
8563
8564 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8565 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8566 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8567
8568 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8569
8570 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8571
8572 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8573 image.
8574
8575 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8576
8577 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8578
8579 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8580 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8581 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8582 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8583 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8584
8585 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8586 has a mask bitmap.
8587
8588 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8589
8590 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8591 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8592 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8593
8594 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8595 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8596
8597 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8598 optional.
8599
8600 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8601 below).
8602
8603 \f
8604 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8605
8606 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8607 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8608
8609 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8610 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8611 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8612 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8613 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8614 just display it black instead.
8615
8616 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8617 a line like
8618
8619 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8620
8621 in your `.emacs'.
8622
8623 ** New face implementation.
8624
8625 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8626 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8627
8628 *** New faces.
8629
8630 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8631
8632 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8633
8634 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8635 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8636
8637 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8638
8639 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8640
8641 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8642
8643 6. Foreground color.
8644
8645 7. Background color.
8646
8647 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8648
8649 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8650
8651 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8652
8653 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8654
8655 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8656 color.
8657
8658 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8659 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8660
8661 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8662 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8663 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8664 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8665 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8666 attributes mentioned above.
8667
8668 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8669 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8670 created frames.
8671
8672 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8673 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8674 `fully-specified'.
8675
8676 *** Face merging.
8677
8678 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8679 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8680 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8681 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8682 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8683 results in a fully-specified face.
8684
8685 *** Face realization.
8686
8687 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8688 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8689 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8690 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8691 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8692 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8693
8694 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8695 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8696 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8697 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8698
8699 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8700 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8701 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8702 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8703 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8704
8705 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8706 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8707 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8708 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8709 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8710 Emacs.
8711
8712 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8713 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8714 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8715 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8716
8717 **** Clearing face caches.
8718
8719 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8720 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8721 unused fonts.
8722
8723 *** Font selection.
8724
8725 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8726 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8727 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8728
8729 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8730 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8731 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8732 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8733 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8734
8735 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8736 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8737 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8738
8739 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8740
8741 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8742 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8743 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8744 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8745 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8746 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8747 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8748
8749 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8750 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8751 doesn't exist.
8752
8753 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8754 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8755 registry.
8756
8757 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8758 slightly different.
8759
8760 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8761
8762
8763 **** Scalable fonts
8764
8765 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8766 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8767 servers.
8768
8769 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8770 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8771 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8772 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8773 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8774 that list. Example:
8775
8776 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8777
8778 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8779
8780 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8781
8782 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8783
8784 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8785 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8786 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8787
8788 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8789 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8790 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8791 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8792 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8793 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8794 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8795 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8796 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8797 of the face font sort order.
8798
8799 - Function: x-font-family-list
8800
8801 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8802 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8803 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8804 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8805
8806 - Variable: font-list-limit
8807
8808 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8809 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8810 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8811
8812 *** Setting face attributes.
8813
8814 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8815 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8816 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8817 `face-attribute'.
8818
8819 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8820 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8821
8822 The following attributes are recognized:
8823
8824 `:family'
8825
8826 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8827 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8828 and `?' are allowed.
8829
8830 `:width'
8831
8832 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8833 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8834 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8835 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8836
8837 `:height'
8838
8839 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8840 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8841 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8842 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8843
8844 `:weight'
8845
8846 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8847 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8848 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8849
8850 `:slant'
8851
8852 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8853 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8854 `reverse-oblique'.
8855
8856 `:foreground', `:background'
8857
8858 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8859
8860 `:underline'
8861
8862 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8863 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8864 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8865 don't underline.
8866
8867 `:overline'
8868
8869 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8870 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8871 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8872 overline.
8873
8874 `:strike-through'
8875
8876 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8877 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8878 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8879 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8880
8881 `:box'
8882
8883 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8884 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8885 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8886 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8887 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8888 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8889 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8890 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8891 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8892 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8893 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8894 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8895 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8896 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8897 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8898 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8899 box.
8900
8901 `:inverse-video'
8902
8903 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8904 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8905
8906 `:stipple'
8907
8908 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8909 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8910 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8911 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8912 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8913 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8914
8915 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8916 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8917
8918 `:font'
8919
8920 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8921 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8922 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8923 versions of Emacs.
8924
8925 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8926 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8927 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8928
8929 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8930 `defface'.
8931
8932 `:inherit'
8933
8934 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8935 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8936 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8937
8938 *** Face attributes and X resources
8939
8940 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8941 from X resources:
8942
8943 Face attribute X resource class
8944 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8945 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8946 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8947 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8948 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8949 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8950 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8951 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8952 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8953 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8954 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8955 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8956 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8957 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8958 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8959 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8960 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8961 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8962 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8963 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8964
8965 *** Text property `face'.
8966
8967 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8968 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8969 specification can be
8970
8971 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8972
8973 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8974 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8975 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8976 for face attribute names.
8977
8978 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8979 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8980 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8981
8982 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8983
8984 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8985 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8986 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
8987 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
8988 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
8989 used to clear the mapping table.
8990
8991 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8992
8993 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8994 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8995 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8996 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8997 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8998 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8999 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9000 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9001 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9002 modify their color-related behavior.
9003
9004 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9005 any frame type.
9006
9007 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9008
9009 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9010 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9011 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9012 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9013 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9014 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9015 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9016 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9017 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9018
9019 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9020 display can display image files.
9021
9022 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9023
9024 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9025 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9026 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9027 `Inviolable' option.
9028
9029 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9030 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9031 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9032
9033 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9034
9035 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9036 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9037 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9038
9039 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9040 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9041 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9042 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9043 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9044 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9045 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9046 functions.
9047
9048 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9049 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9050 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9051
9052 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9053
9054 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9055
9056 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9057
9058 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9059 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9060 constrained position if that is different.
9061
9062 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9063 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9064 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9065 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9066 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9067 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9068 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9069 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9070 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9071
9072 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9073 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9074 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9075 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9076 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9077
9078 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9079 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9080
9081 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9082
9083 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9084
9085 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9086 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9087 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9088
9089 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9090
9091 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9092 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9093 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9094 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9095 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9096
9097 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9098
9099 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9100 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9101 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9102 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9103 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9104
9105 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9106
9107 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9108 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9109 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9110
9111 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9112
9113 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9114 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9115 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9116
9117 ** Image support.
9118
9119 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9120 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9121 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9122 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9123
9124 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9125 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9126 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9127 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9128 area.
9129
9130 IMAGE is an image specification.
9131
9132 *** Image specifications
9133
9134 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9135 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9136 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9137 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9138 described below are ignored.
9139
9140 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9141
9142 `:ascent ASCENT'
9143
9144 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9145 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9146 to use for its ascent.
9147
9148 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9149 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9150
9151 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9152 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9153 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9154 overlays that apply to the image.
9155
9156 `:margin MARGIN'
9157
9158 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9159 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9160 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9161
9162 `:relief RELIEF'
9163
9164 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9165 around an image.
9166
9167 `:conversion ALGO'
9168
9169 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9170
9171 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9172 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9173
9174 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9175 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9176 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9177 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9178 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9179 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9180 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9181 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9182 below.
9183
9184 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9185 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9186 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9187
9188 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9189 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9190 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9191 of the factors' absolute values.
9192
9193 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9194
9195 (1 0 0
9196 0 0 0
9197 9 9 -1)
9198
9199 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9200
9201 ( 2 -1 0
9202 -1 0 1
9203 0 1 -2)
9204
9205 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9206 ``disabled''.
9207
9208 `:mask MASK'
9209
9210 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9211 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9212 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9213 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9214 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9215 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9216 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9217 image.
9218
9219 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9220 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9221 `:mask nil'.
9222
9223 `:file FILE'
9224
9225 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9226 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9227 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9228 may be present in the image specification.
9229
9230 `:data DATA'
9231
9232 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9233 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9234 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9235 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9236
9237 *** Supported image types
9238
9239 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9240
9241 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9242 properties supported are:
9243
9244 `:foreground FG'
9245
9246 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9247 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9248
9249 `:background BG'
9250
9251 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9252 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9253
9254 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9255 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9256 instead of a `:file' property.
9257
9258 `:width WIDTH'
9259
9260 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9261
9262 `:height HEIGHT'
9263
9264 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9265
9266 `:data DATA'
9267
9268 DATA must be either
9269
9270 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9271 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9272
9273 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9274
9275 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9276 bitmap.
9277
9278 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9279 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9280 in the file.
9281
9282 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9283
9284 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9285 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9286 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9287 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9288
9289 Additional image properties supported are:
9290
9291 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9292
9293 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9294 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9295 name.
9296
9297 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9298 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9299
9300 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9301 to display compressed images.
9302
9303 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9304
9305 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9306 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9307 mono images are:
9308
9309 `:foreground FG'
9310
9311 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9312 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9313
9314 `:background FG'
9315
9316 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9317 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9318
9319 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9320
9321 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9322 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9323 properties defined.
9324
9325 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9326
9327 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9328 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9329 properties defined.
9330
9331 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9332
9333 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9334 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9335
9336 Additional image properties supported are:
9337
9338 `:index INDEX'
9339
9340 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9341 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9342 as a hollow box.
9343
9344 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9345 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9346 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9347 every 0.1 seconds.
9348
9349 (defun show-anim (file max)
9350 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9351 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9352
9353 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9354 (when (= idx max)
9355 (setq idx 0))
9356 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9357 (save-excursion
9358 (set-buffer buffer)
9359 (goto-char (point-min))
9360 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9361 (insert-image img "x"))
9362 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9363
9364 **** PNG, image type `png'
9365
9366 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9367 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9368 properties defined.
9369
9370 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9371
9372 Additional image properties supported are:
9373
9374 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9375
9376 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9377 integer. This is a required property.
9378
9379 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9380
9381 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
9382 must be a integer. This is an required property.
9383
9384 `:bounding-box BOX'
9385
9386 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
9387 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
9388 files. This is an required property.
9389
9390 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
9391 lisp/gs.el.
9392
9393 *** Lisp interface.
9394
9395 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
9396 which are supported in the current configuration.
9397
9398 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
9399 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
9400 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
9401 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
9402 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
9403
9404 *** Simplified image API, image.el
9405
9406 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
9407 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
9408 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
9409 define an image based on available image types. The functions
9410 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
9411 buffer.
9412
9413 ** Display margins.
9414
9415 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
9416 and images.
9417
9418 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
9419 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
9420 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
9421 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
9422 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
9423 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
9424 of the display margins.
9425
9426 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
9427 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
9428 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
9429 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
9430 in this file).
9431
9432 ** Help display
9433
9434 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
9435 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
9436 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
9437 that have a `help-echo' property.
9438
9439 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
9440 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
9441 the window in which the help was found.
9442
9443 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
9444 `help-echo' text property was found.
9445
9446 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
9447 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
9448
9449 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
9450 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
9451 mouse.
9452
9453 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
9454 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
9455
9456 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
9457 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
9458 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
9459 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
9460 used as help string.
9461
9462 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
9463 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
9464 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
9465
9466 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
9467
9468 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
9469 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
9470
9471 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
9472 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
9473 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
9474 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
9475 used.
9476
9477 (global-set-key [A-down]
9478 #'(lambda ()
9479 (interactive)
9480 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9481 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9482 (global-set-key [A-up]
9483 #'(lambda ()
9484 (interactive)
9485 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9486 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9487
9488 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9489
9490 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9491 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9492 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9493 is called with one argument, POS.
9494
9495 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9496 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9497 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9498 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9499 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9500
9501 ** Tool bar support.
9502
9503 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9504 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9505 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9506 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9507 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9508 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9509
9510 *** Tool bar item definitions
9511
9512 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9513 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9514 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9515
9516 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9517 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9518 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9519 property (see below).
9520
9521 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9522 binding are currently ignored.
9523
9524 The following properties are recognized:
9525
9526 `:enable FORM'.
9527
9528 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9529 or disabled.
9530
9531 `:visible FORM'
9532
9533 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9534
9535 `:filter FUNCTION'
9536
9537 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9538 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9539 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9540
9541 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9542
9543 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9544 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9545
9546 `:image IMAGES'
9547
9548 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9549 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9550 meaning of each of the four elements:
9551
9552 Index Use when item is
9553 ----------------------------------------
9554 0 enabled and selected
9555 1 enabled and deselected
9556 2 disabled and selected
9557 3 disabled and deselected
9558
9559 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9560 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9561
9562 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9563
9564 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9565 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9566
9567 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9568 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9569 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9570 menu bar.
9571
9572 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9573 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9574 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9575
9576 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9577
9578 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9579 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9580 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9581
9582 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9583 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9584
9585 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9586 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9587 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9588 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9589
9590 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9591 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9592
9593 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9594
9595 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9596 a tool bar item. If
9597
9598 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9599 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9600 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9601
9602 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9603
9604 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9605
9606 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9607 item.
9608
9609 ** Mode line changes.
9610
9611 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9612
9613 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9614 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9615 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9616
9617 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9618 a `local-map' text property.
9619
9620 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9621 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9622
9623 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9624 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9625 `local-map' property.
9626
9627 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9628 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9629 example.
9630
9631 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9632 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9633
9634 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9635 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9636
9637 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9638
9639 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9640 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9641 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9642 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9643 line.
9644
9645 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9646 `header-line'.
9647
9648 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9649 position in the header-line.
9650
9651 ** Text property `display'
9652
9653 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9654 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9655 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9656 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9657 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9658
9659 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9660
9661 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9662 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9663
9664 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9665 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9666 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9667 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9668 simpler form STRING as property value.
9669
9670 *** Variable width and height spaces
9671
9672 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9673 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9674 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9675 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9676 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9677 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9678 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9679
9680 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9681 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9682 properties described below.
9683
9684 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9685 characters having the `display' property.
9686
9687 - :width WIDTH
9688
9689 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9690 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9691
9692 - :relative-width FACTOR
9693
9694 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9695 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9696 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9697 width of that character by FACTOR.
9698
9699 - :align-to HPOS
9700
9701 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9702 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9703
9704 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9705
9706 - :height HEIGHT
9707
9708 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9709 normal line height.
9710
9711 - :relative-height FACTOR
9712
9713 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9714 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9715
9716 - :ascent ASCENT
9717
9718 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9719 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9720 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9721 equal to 100.
9722
9723 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9724
9725 *** Images
9726
9727 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9728 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9729 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9730 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9731 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9732 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9733 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9734 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9735 as display specification.
9736
9737 *** Other display properties
9738
9739 - (space-width FACTOR)
9740
9741 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9742 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9743 integer or float.
9744
9745 - (height HEIGHT)
9746
9747 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9748
9749 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9750 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9751 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9752 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9753 a font is available counts as a step.
9754
9755 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9756 as tall as the frame's default font.
9757
9758 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9759 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9760
9761 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9762 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9763
9764 - (raise FACTOR)
9765
9766 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9767 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9768 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9769 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9770 `height' subproperty.
9771
9772 *** Conditional display properties
9773
9774 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9775 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9776 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9777 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9778 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9779 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9780 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9781 different when object is a string.
9782
9783 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9784 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9785
9786 ** New menu separator types.
9787
9788 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9789 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9790 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9791 to specify other menu separator types.
9792
9793 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9794
9795 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9796 separator occurs.
9797
9798 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9799
9800 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9801
9802 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9803
9804 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9805
9806 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9807
9808 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9809
9810 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9811
9812 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9813
9814 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9815
9816 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9817 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9818
9819 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9820
9821 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9822
9823 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9824
9825 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9826
9827 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9828
9829 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9830
9831 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9832
9833 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9834
9835 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9836
9837 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9838
9839 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9840
9841 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9842
9843 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9844
9845 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9846
9847 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9848 the corresponding single-line separators.
9849
9850 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9851
9852 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9853 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9854 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9855 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9856 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9857 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9858 default foreground is black.
9859
9860 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9861 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9862 `ScrollBarBackground').
9863
9864 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9865 settings for scroll bar colors.
9866
9867 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9868 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9869
9870 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9871 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9872 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9873 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9874 the original window start.
9875
9876 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9877 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9878 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9879
9880 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9881
9882 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9883 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9884 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9885 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9886
9887 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9888 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9889
9890 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9891
9892 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9893 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9894 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9895 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9896 temporarily to nil, for example
9897
9898 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9899 (enlarge-window 10))
9900
9901 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9902 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9903
9904 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9905 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9906 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9907 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9908 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9909 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9910
9911
9912 \f
9913 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9914
9915 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9916 input.
9917
9918 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9919
9920 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9921
9922 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9923 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9924 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9925 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9926 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9927
9928 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9929 been added.
9930
9931 \f
9932 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9933
9934 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9935
9936
9937 \f
9938 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9939
9940 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9941 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9942 \f
9943 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9944
9945 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9946
9947 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9948 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9949 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9950
9951 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9952 is the one that is used.
9953
9954 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9955 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9956 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9957 separate from the command's regular output.
9958 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9959 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9960 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9961 the buffer name.
9962
9963 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9964 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9965 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9966 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9967
9968 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9969 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9970 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9971 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9972
9973 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9974 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9975 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9976 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9977
9978 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9979 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9980 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9981 they never ignore case.
9982
9983 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9984 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9985 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9986 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9987 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9988 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9989 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9990
9991 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9992 the same format that was used in the file before.
9993
9994 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9995 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9996
9997 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9998 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9999 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10000
10001 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10002 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10003 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10004 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10005 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10006 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10007 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10008
10009 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10010 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10011 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10012 format. You can now customize these variables.
10013
10014 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10015 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10016 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10017 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10018
10019 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10020 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10021 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10022
10023 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10024 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10025 doesn't have any effect.
10026
10027 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10028 not one per buffer.
10029
10030 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10031 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10032 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10033
10034 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10035 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10036 `auto-show-mode' command.
10037
10038 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10039 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10040 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10041 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10042 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10043
10044 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10045 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10046
10047 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10048 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10049 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10050
10051 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10052 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10053 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10054 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10055
10056 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10057
10058 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10059 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10060 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10061 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10062 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10063
10064 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10065 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10066
10067 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10068 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10069 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10070 `?' on other systems.
10071
10072 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10073 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10074 Unix.
10075
10076 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10077 current codepage when it starts.
10078
10079 ** Mail changes
10080
10081 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10082 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10083 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10084 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10085 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10086 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10087 latin-1:
10088
10089 MIME-version: 1.0
10090 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10091 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10092
10093 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10094 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10095 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10096 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10097 buffer-file-coding-system.
10098
10099 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10100 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10101 mail.
10102
10103 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10104 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10105 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10106 list of possible coding systems.
10107
10108 ** CC Mode changes
10109
10110 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10111 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10112 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10113 docstring for details.
10114
10115 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10116 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10117 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10118 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10119 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10120
10121 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10122 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10123
10124 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10125 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10126
10127 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10128 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10129 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10130 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10131 anonymous classes.
10132
10133 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10134 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10135
10136 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10137 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10138 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10139 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10140
10141 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10142 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10143 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10144 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10145 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10146
10147 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10148
10149 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10150
10151 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10152 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10153
10154 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10155
10156 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10157 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10158 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10159 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10160 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10161
10162 ** Gnus changes.
10163
10164 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10165 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10166 Gnus manual for the full story.
10167
10168 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10169 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10170 group, which is created automatically.
10171
10172 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10173 values.
10174
10175 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10176
10177 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10178 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10179
10180 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10181 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10182
10183 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10184
10185 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10186 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10187
10188 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10189
10190 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10191 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10192
10193 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10194 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10195
10196 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10197 control over simplification.
10198
10199 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10200
10201 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10202 limit.
10203
10204 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10205
10206 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10207
10208 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10209 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10210 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10211
10212 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10213 `a' forces normal posting method.
10214
10215 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10216 -- `W d'.
10217
10218 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10219 to a non-nil value.
10220
10221 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10222 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10223
10224 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10225 has been added.
10226
10227 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10228
10229 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10230
10231 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10232 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10233
10234 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10235 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10236
10237 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10238
10239 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10240 been added.
10241
10242 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10243 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10244
10245 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10246 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10247
10248 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10249
10250 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10251
10252 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10253
10254 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10255
10256 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10257 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10258 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10259
10260 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10261 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10262 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10263 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10264 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10265
10266 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10267 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10268 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10269 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10270
10271 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10272 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10273 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10274 mismatch.
10275
10276 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10277
10278 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10279 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10280
10281 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10282 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10283 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10284 removed from the label.
10285
10286 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10287 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10288
10289 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10290 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10291
10292 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10293 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10294 expressions.
10295
10296 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10297
10298 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10299
10300 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10301 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10302
10303 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10304 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10305 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10306
10307 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
10308 changes with a special face.
10309
10310 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10311 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10312 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10313 \f
10314 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10315
10316 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10317 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10318 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10319 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10320 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10321
10322 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10323 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10324 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10325
10326 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10327 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10328 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10329 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10330 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10331 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10332 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10333 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10334 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10335
10336 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10337 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10338 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10339 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10340 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10341 program.
10342
10343 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10344 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10345 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10346 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10347 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10348 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10349
10350 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10351 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10352 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10353 was not documented clearly before.
10354
10355 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10356 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10357 \f
10358 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10359
10360 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10361 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10362 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10363 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10364
10365 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10366 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10367 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10368
10369 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10370
10371 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10372 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10373
10374 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10375 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10376 integers.
10377
10378 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10379 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10380 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10381 file names and attributes are returned.
10382
10383 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10384 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
10385 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
10386 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
10387 returns the result.
10388
10389 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
10390 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
10391
10392 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
10393
10394 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
10395 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
10396 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
10397 optionally.
10398
10399 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
10400 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
10401
10402 **
10403 The new function process-running-child-p
10404 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
10405 terminal to its own child process.
10406
10407 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
10408 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
10409 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
10410 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
10411
10412 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
10413 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
10414
10415 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
10416 :included is an alias for :visible.
10417
10418 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
10419 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
10420 to move or copy menu entries.
10421
10422 ** Multibyte editing changes
10423
10424 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
10425 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
10426 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
10427 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
10428 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
10429 (setq char (sref str idx)
10430 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
10431 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
10432
10433 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
10434 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
10435 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
10436
10437 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
10438 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
10439 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
10440
10441 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
10442
10443 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
10444 across the boundary.
10445
10446 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
10447 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
10448 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
10449 contains 8-bit characters.
10450 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
10451 contains invalid characters.
10452
10453 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
10454 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
10455 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
10456 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
10457 way.
10458
10459 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
10460 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
10461 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
10462 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
10463
10464 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
10465 compose Thai characters in a string.
10466
10467 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
10468 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
10469 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
10470 menus should always use the third argument.
10471
10472 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
10473 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
10474 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
10475 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
10476
10477 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
10478 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10479 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10480 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10481
10482 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10483 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10484 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10485 echo area contents.
10486
10487 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10488
10489 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10490 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10491 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10492
10493 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10494 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10495 means to clear out that attribute.
10496
10497 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10498 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10499
10500 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10501 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10502 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10503 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10504
10505 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10506 the gap of the current buffer.
10507
10508 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10509 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10510 current buffer.
10511
10512 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10513 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10514 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10515 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10516 \f
10517 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10518
10519 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10520 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10521 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10522 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10523 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10524
10525 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10526 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10527 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10528 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10529 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10530
10531 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10532 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10533 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10534
10535 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10536 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10537 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10538 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10539 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10540 results.
10541
10542 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10543 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10544 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10545 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10546 \f
10547 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10548
10549 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10550 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10551 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10552 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10553
10554 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10555 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10556 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10557 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10558 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10559 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10560 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10561 region.
10562
10563 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10564 selective undo.
10565
10566 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10567 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10568 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10569 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10570 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10571
10572 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10573 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10574 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10575 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10576
10577 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10578 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10579 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10580 something that most users not do.
10581
10582 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10583 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10584 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10585 applications.
10586
10587 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10588 pasting operations.
10589
10590 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10591 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10592 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10593 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10594 `ps-printer-name'.
10595
10596 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10597 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10598 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10599 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10600 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10601 hits a new word.
10602
10603 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10604 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10605 to be confused by TeX commands.
10606
10607 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10608 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10609 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10610 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10611
10612 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10613 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10614 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10615 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10616 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10617
10618 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10619 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10620
10621 ** Changes in input method usage.
10622
10623 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10624 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10625 respectively.
10626
10627 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10628
10629 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10630 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10631
10632 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10633 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10634
10635 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10636
10637 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10638
10639 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10640 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10641
10642 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10643 given in the following case:
10644 o When you are using a complex input method.
10645 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10646
10647 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10648 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10649 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10650 setting it to t is helpful.
10651
10652 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10653
10654 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10655 keys:
10656 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10657 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10658 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10659 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10660 environment.
10661
10662 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10663 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10664 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10665 get
10666
10667 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10668
10669 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10670
10671 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10672 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10673
10674 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10675 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10676 its owner and group.
10677
10678 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10679 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10680
10681 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10682 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10683
10684 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10685 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10686 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10687 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10688
10689 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10690 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10691 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10692 for writing keyboard macros.
10693
10694 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10695 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10696 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10697 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10698 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10699 info.
10700
10701 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10702
10703 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10704 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10705 contents only.
10706
10707 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10708 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10709 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10710 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10711
10712 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10713 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10714 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10715
10716 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10717 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10718 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10719 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10720
10721 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10722 failure if the command produces no output.
10723
10724 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10725 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10726 the mouse.
10727
10728 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10729 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10730 function and variable names.
10731
10732 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10733 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10734 file-coding-system-alist.
10735
10736 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10737 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10738 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10739 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10740 according to the current fontset.
10741
10742 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10743
10744 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10745 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10746 nonascii-insert-offset.
10747
10748 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10749 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10750 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10751 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10752
10753 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10754 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10755
10756 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10757 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10758
10759 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10760 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10761 command keys.
10762
10763 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10764 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10765
10766 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10767 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10768 all variables that have documentation.
10769
10770 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10771 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10772 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10773 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10774 it should show; the default is 20.
10775
10776 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10777 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10778 of your input.
10779
10780 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10781 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10782 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10783 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10784 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10785 Newly added options are included as well.
10786
10787 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10788 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10789 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10790
10791 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10792 Customize menu.
10793
10794 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10795 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10796
10797 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10798 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10799 invoked.
10800
10801 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10802 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10803 The default is 1.
10804
10805 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10806 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10807 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10808 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10809 sensibly.
10810
10811 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10812
10813 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10814 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10815 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10816
10817 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10818 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10819 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10820 every night.
10821
10822 ** Desktop changes
10823
10824 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10825 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10826
10827 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10828 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10829
10830 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10831 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10832
10833 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10834 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10835 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10836 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10837 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10838 made invisible again.
10839
10840 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10841
10842 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10843 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10844 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10845 toggle.
10846
10847 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10848 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10849 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10850 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10851 rmail-default-body-file.
10852
10853 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10854 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10855 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10856
10857 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10858 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10859 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10860
10861 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10862 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10863 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10864 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10865 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10866 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10867
10868 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10869 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10870 provided by feedmail are:
10871
10872 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10873 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10874 there is also a queue for draft messages
10875
10876 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10877 be prompted for confirmation
10878
10879 **** does smart filling of address headers
10880
10881 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10882 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10883 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10884
10885 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10886 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10887 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10888 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
10889
10890 ** Dired changes
10891
10892 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10893 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10894
10895 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10896 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10897
10898 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10899 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10900 for a specified regexp.
10901
10902 ** VC Changes
10903
10904 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10905 conveniently.
10906
10907 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10908 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10909 Dired.
10910
10911 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10912 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10913 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10914 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10915
10916 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10917 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10918 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10919 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10920 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10921
10922 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10923 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10924 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10925 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10926 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10927
10928 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10929 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10930 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10931 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10932
10933 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10934 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10935 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10936
10937 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10938 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10939 session to resolve them.
10940
10941 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10942 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10943 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10944 uses as well).
10945
10946 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10947 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10948 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10949 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10950 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10951 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10952 using ediff.
10953
10954 ** Changes in Font Lock
10955
10956 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10957 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10958 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10959 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10960 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10961
10962 ** Frame name display changes
10963
10964 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10965 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10966 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10967 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10968
10969 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10970 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10971 menu.
10972
10973 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10974
10975 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10976 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10977 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10978
10979 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10980
10981 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10982 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10983 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10984
10985 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10986 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10987 the following line.
10988
10989 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10990 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10991 previously sent input.
10992
10993 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10994 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10995 as the search string.
10996
10997 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10998 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10999
11000 ** C mode changes
11001
11002 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11003 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11004 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11005 definition.
11006
11007 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11008 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11009 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11010 style is still the default however.
11011
11012 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11013
11014 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11015 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11016 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11017
11018 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11019 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11020
11021 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11022 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11023
11024 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11025 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11026
11027 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11028 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11029
11030 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11031 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11032 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11033 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11034
11035 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11036
11037 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11038 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11039 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11040
11041 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11042 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11043 expanding dynamically.
11044
11045 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11046 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11047
11048 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11049 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11050 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11051 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11052
11053 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11054
11055 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11056
11057 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11058 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11059 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11060 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11061 against the first word in the title.
11062
11063 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11064 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11065 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11066 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11067 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11068 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11069
11070 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11071 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11072 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11073 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11074
11075 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11076
11077 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11078 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11079 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11080 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11081 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11082 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11083
11084 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11085 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11086
11087 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11088 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11089 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11090
11091 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11092 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11093
11094 ** Ispell changes.
11095
11096 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11097 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11098 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11099
11100 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11101 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11102 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11103 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11104 include:
11105
11106 o URLs are automatically skipped
11107 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11108
11109 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11110
11111 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11112
11113 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11114 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11115 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11116 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11117
11118 *** New recursive parser.
11119
11120 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11121 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11122 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11123
11124 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11125
11126 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11127 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11128 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11129
11130 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11131
11132 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11133
11134 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11135
11136 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11137
11138 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11139
11140 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11141 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11142
11143 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11144
11145 *** References to external documents.
11146
11147 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11148 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11149 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11150 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11151 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11152 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11153 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11154
11155 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11156
11157 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11158 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11159
11160 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11161 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11162
11163 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11164
11165 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11166 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11167
11168 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11169
11170 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11171 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11172 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11173 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11174 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11175 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11176 more.
11177
11178 *** Support for the varioref package
11179
11180 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11181
11182 *** New hooks
11183
11184 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11185 and citations are created. These hooks are
11186 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11187 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11188
11189 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11190
11191 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11192 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11193
11194 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11195
11196 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11197 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11198 fontified, use
11199
11200 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11201
11202 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11203 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11204 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11205 directories that contain the same file name.
11206
11207 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11208 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11209 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11210 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11211 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11212 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11213 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11214 directory.
11215
11216 ** New modes and packages
11217
11218 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11219 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11220 it, but some do not.
11221
11222 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11223 code.
11224
11225 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11226 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11227 around in a buffer.
11228
11229 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11230
11231 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11232 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11233 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11234 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11235
11236 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11237 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11238 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11239
11240 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11241 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11242 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
11243 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11244 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11245 the like.
11246
11247 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11248 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11249
11250 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11251 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11252 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11253 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11254
11255 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11256
11257 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11258 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11259 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11260 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11261 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
11262 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11263 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11264 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11265 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11266 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11267 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11268
11269 Platform-specific modes:
11270
11271 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11272 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11273 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11274 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11275 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11276 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11277 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11278 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11279 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11280 \f
11281 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11282
11283 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11284 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11285 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11286 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11287
11288 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11289 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11290 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11291
11292 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11293 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11294 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11295 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11296
11297 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11298 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11299 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11300 environment.
11301
11302 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11303 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11304 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11305 current input method for reading this one event.
11306
11307 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11308 now control whether to output certain characters as
11309 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11310 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11311 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11312 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11313 \f
11314 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11315
11316 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11317 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11318
11319 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11320 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11321 always increases point by 1.
11322
11323 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11324 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11325
11326 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11327
11328 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11329 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11330 default value changed. For example,
11331
11332 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11333 :type 'integer
11334 :group 'foo
11335 :version "20.3")
11336
11337 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11338 :version "20.3")
11339
11340 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11341 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11342 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11343 `:version' in the top level group.
11344
11345 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11346
11347 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11348 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11349
11350 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11351 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11352 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11353 to themselves.
11354
11355 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11356 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11357 values whatever.
11358
11359 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11360 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11361 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11362
11363 ** Frame-local variables.
11364
11365 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11366 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11367 local bindings for that variable.
11368
11369 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11370 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11371 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11372 parameter name.
11373
11374 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11375 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11376 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11377 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11378
11379 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11380 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11381 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11382 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11383
11384 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
11385 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
11386 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
11387 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
11388 See the documentation in sregex.el.
11389
11390 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
11391 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
11392 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
11393 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
11394
11395 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
11396 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
11397
11398 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
11399 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
11400 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
11401
11402 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
11403 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
11404 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
11405 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
11406
11407 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
11408 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
11409 empty input.
11410
11411 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
11412 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
11413 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
11414 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
11415 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
11416
11417 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
11418 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
11419 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
11420 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
11421
11422 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
11423 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
11424 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
11425 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
11426 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
11427
11428 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
11429 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
11430 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
11431 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
11432
11433 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
11434 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
11435 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
11436
11437 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
11438 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
11439 was directed to display this buffer.
11440
11441 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
11442 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
11443 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
11444 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
11445 set-window-configuration.
11446
11447 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
11448 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
11449 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
11450 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
11451
11452 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
11453 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
11454 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
11455
11456 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
11457 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
11458 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
11459
11460 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
11461 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
11462
11463 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
11464 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
11465
11466 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
11467 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
11468 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
11469
11470 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
11471 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
11472 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
11473 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
11474
11475 ** Menu changes
11476
11477 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
11478 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11479 better supported.
11480
11481 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11482 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11483 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11484 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11485 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11486
11487 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11488
11489 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11490 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11491 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11492 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11493
11494 The format is:
11495 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11496 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11497 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11498 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11499 The supported properties include
11500
11501 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11502 item is enabled.
11503 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11504 item should appear in the menu.
11505 :filter FILTER-FN
11506 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11507 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11508 It should return a binding to use instead.
11509 :keys DESCRIPTION
11510 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11511 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11512 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11513 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11514 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11515 keyboard binding.
11516 :key-sequence nil
11517 This means that the command normally has no
11518 keyboard equivalent.
11519 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11520 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11521 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11522 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11523 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11524
11525 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11526 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11527
11528 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11529
11530 ** New event types
11531
11532 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11533 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11534 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11535 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11536
11537 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11538
11539 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11540 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11541 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11542 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11543 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11544 forward, away from the user.
11545
11546 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11547
11548 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11549 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11550 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11551 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11552 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11553
11554 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11555
11556 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11557 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11558 that were dragged and dropped.
11559
11560 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11561
11562 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11563
11564 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11565 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11566 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11567
11568 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11569 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11570 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11571
11572 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11573 in Emacs 19 and before.
11574
11575 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11576 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11577
11578 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11579 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11580 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11581 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11582
11583 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11584 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11585 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11586 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11587 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11588
11589 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11590 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11591 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11592 consistent with the new representation.
11593
11594 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11595 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11596 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11597 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11598
11599 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11600 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11601 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11602
11603 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11604 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11605 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11606
11607 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11608 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11609 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11610
11611 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11612 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11613
11614 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11615 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11616
11617 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11618 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11619 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11620 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11621
11622 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11623 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11624
11625 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11626 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11627 buffer or string being searched.
11628
11629 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11630 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11631 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11632 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11633 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11634 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11635 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11636
11637 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11638
11639 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11640 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11641 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11642 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11643 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11644 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11645 define-coding-system-alias.
11646
11647 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11648 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11649 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11650 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11651 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11652 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11653 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11654 `iso-8859-1'.
11655
11656 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11657 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11658 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11659 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11660
11661 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11662 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11663 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11664 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11665
11666 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11667 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11668 This function requires a user interaction.
11669
11670 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11671 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11672 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11673 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11674 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11675 select-safe-coding-system.
11676
11677 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11678 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11679 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11680 was done.
11681
11682 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11683 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11684 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11685
11686 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11687 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11688 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11689 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11690
11691 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11692 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11693 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11694 converted.
11695
11696 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11697 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11698
11699 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11700 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11701 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11702 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11703 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11704 range of characters.
11705
11706 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11707 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11708
11709 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11710 in the current buffer at position POS.
11711
11712 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11713 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11714 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11715 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11716 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11717 binding input-method-function to nil.
11718
11719 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11720 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11721 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11722 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11723 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11724
11725 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11726 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11727
11728 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11729 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11730
11731 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11732 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11733 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11734 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11735 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11736 \f
11737 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11738
11739 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11740 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11741 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11742 tree structure.
11743
11744 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11745 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11746
11747 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11748 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11749 in your .emacs file.)
11750
11751 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11752 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11753
11754 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11755 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11756
11757 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11758 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11759 kills the region.
11760
11761 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11762 delete the character before point, as usual.
11763
11764 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11765 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11766 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11767
11768 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11769 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11770 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11771 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11772 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11773 past.)
11774
11775 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11776 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11777 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11778 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11779 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11780
11781 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11782 and is an alias for it.
11783
11784 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11785 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11786
11787 ** Scrolling changes
11788
11789 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11790 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11791
11792 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11793 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11794 where it started.
11795
11796 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11797 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11798 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11799 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11800
11801 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11802 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11803 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11804 recenters the window.
11805
11806 ** International character set support (MULE)
11807
11808 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11809 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11810 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11811 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11812 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11813 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11814
11815 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11816 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11817 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11818 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11819 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11820
11821 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11822 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11823 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11824 language, to make it possible to type them.
11825
11826 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11827 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11828
11829 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11830 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11831
11832 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11833
11834 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11835
11836 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11837 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11838 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11839 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11840 characters for their work until they want to change.
11841
11842 *** Input methods
11843
11844 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11845 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11846 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11847 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11848 support several input methods.
11849
11850 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11851 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11852 work.
11853
11854 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11855 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11856 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11857 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11858 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11859 letter.
11860
11861 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11862 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11863 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11864 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11865 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11866
11867 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11868 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11869 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11870 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11871
11872 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11873 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11874 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11875 the first guess is wrong.
11876
11877 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11878 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11879
11880 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11881 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11882 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11883 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11884
11885 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11886 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11887 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11888 translate automatically to and from either one.
11889
11890 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11891
11892 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11893 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11894 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11895 what you want.
11896
11897 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11898 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11899 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11900 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11901
11902 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11903 character conversion as well.
11904
11905 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11906
11907 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11908 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11909 requires using many fonts.
11910
11911 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11912 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11913
11914 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11915 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11916 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11917 you would use a font.
11918
11919 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11920 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11921 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11922
11923 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11924 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11925 characters).
11926
11927 *** Defining fontsets.
11928
11929 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11930 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11931 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11932
11933 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11934 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11935 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11936 standard fontset are created automatically.
11937
11938 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11939 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11940 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11941 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11942 name is `fontset-startup'.
11943
11944 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11945 The resource value should have this form:
11946 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11947 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11948 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11949 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11950 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11951 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11952 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11953 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11954 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11955
11956 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11957 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11958 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11959
11960 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11961 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11962 following resource,
11963 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11964 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11965 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11966 Here is the substitution rule:
11967 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11968 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11969 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11970 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11971 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11972
11973 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11974 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11975 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11976
11977 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11978 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11979 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11980 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11981 fontsets.
11982
11983 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11984 defaults for a particular choice of language.
11985
11986 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11987 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11988 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11989 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11990 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11991 system for new files that you create.
11992
11993 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11994 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11995 whole Emacs session.
11996
11997 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11998 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11999 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12000
12001 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12002 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12003 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12004 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12005 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12006
12007 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12008 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12009 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12010 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12011 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12012
12013 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12014 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12015
12016 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12017 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12018
12019 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12020 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12021
12022 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12023 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12024 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12025 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12026 of the file.
12027
12028 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12029 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12030 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12031 translated into that character code.
12032
12033 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12034 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12035
12036 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12037
12038 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12039 the coding system for keyboard input.
12040
12041 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12042 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12043 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12044
12045 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12046
12047 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12048 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12049 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12050 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12051 designed to work with terminals.
12052
12053 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12054 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12055 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12056 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12057 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12058 in the corresponding buffer.
12059
12060 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12061
12062 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12063 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12064 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12065
12066 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12067 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12068 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12069 want to use.
12070
12071 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12072 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12073
12074 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12075 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12076 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12077 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12078
12079 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12080 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12081 related information.
12082
12083 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12084 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12085 scripts.
12086
12087 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12088 information about the support for a particular language.
12089 You specify the language as an argument.
12090
12091 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12092 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12093 first dash.
12094
12095 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12096 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12097 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12098 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12099
12100 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12101 B big5 (Chinese)
12102 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12103 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12104 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12105 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12106 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12107 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12108 K euc-korea (Korean)
12109 R koi8 (Russian)
12110 Q tibetan
12111 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12112 T lao
12113 T tis620 (Thai)
12114 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12115 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12116 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12117 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12118 z hz (Chinese)
12119
12120 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12121 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12122 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12123 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12124
12125 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12126 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12127
12128 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12129 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12130 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12131 Rmail files themselves.
12132
12133 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12134 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12135
12136 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12137 for sending mail:
12138
12139 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12140 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12141 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12142 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12143 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12144
12145 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12146 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12147 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12148 translations.
12149
12150 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12151 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12152 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12153 without any conversion.
12154
12155 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12156 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12157 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12158 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12159
12160 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12161 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12162
12163 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12164 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12165
12166 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12167 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12168
12169 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12170 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12171 in the buffer before point.
12172
12173 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12174 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12175 you are using.
12176
12177 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12178 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12179
12180 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12181
12182 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12183 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12184
12185 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12186 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12187 can become a bottleneck.
12188
12189 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12190 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12191 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12192 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12193 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12194 so useful that the change is worth while.
12195
12196 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12197 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12198 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12199 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12200
12201 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12202 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12203 show-paren-mode.
12204
12205 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12206 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12207 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12208
12209 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12210 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12211 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12212
12213 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12214 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12215 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12216
12217 ** Changes in View mode.
12218
12219 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12220 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12221
12222 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12223 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12224
12225 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12226 previous state.
12227
12228 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12229 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12230
12231 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12232 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12233 not just the selected window.
12234
12235 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12236 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12237 turns View mode on or off.
12238
12239 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12240 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12241 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12242
12243 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12244 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12245
12246 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12247 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12248 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12249 which version to compare with.
12250
12251 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12252 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12253
12254 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12255 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12256 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12257 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12258
12259 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12260 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12261 blocks, all of them or none.
12262
12263 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12264 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12265 confirmation first.
12266
12267 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12268 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12269 However, the mode will not be changed if
12270 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12271 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12272 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12273 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12274
12275 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12276
12277 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12278 these commands do not change the major mode.
12279
12280 ** M-x occur changes.
12281
12282 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12283 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12284
12285 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12286 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12287 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12288
12289 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12290 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12291 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12292 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12293 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12294
12295 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12296 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12297 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12298 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12299
12300 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12301 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12302 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12303
12304 ** Outline mode changes.
12305
12306 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12307
12308 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12309
12310 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12311 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12312 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12313 was already active.
12314
12315 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12316 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12317 get confused by it.
12318
12319 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12320 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12321
12322 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12323
12324 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12325 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12326 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12327 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12328
12329 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12330 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12331 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12332
12333 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12334 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12335 values.
12336
12337 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12338 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12339 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12340 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12341
12342 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12343 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12344 can be. The default value is 30.
12345
12346 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12347
12348 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12349 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12350 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12351 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12352 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12353 behavior.
12354
12355 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12356 compose-mail-other-frame.
12357
12358 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12359 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12360 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12361 buffer that shows the original message.
12362
12363 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12364 with separator lines around the contents.
12365
12366 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12367 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12368 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12369 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12370
12371 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12372
12373 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12374 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12375 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12376 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12377
12378 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12379 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12380 /etc/passwd.
12381
12382 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12383 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12384 /etc/passwd.
12385
12386 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
12387 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
12388 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
12389 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
12390
12391 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
12392 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
12393 be taken to be magic.
12394
12395 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
12396 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
12397 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
12398
12399 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
12400 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
12401
12402 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
12403 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
12404
12405 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
12406
12407 new key dired.el binding old key
12408 ------- ---------------- -------
12409 * c dired-change-marks c
12410 * m dired-mark m
12411 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
12412 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
12413 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
12414 * u dired-unmark u
12415 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
12416 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
12417 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
12418 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
12419 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
12420 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
12421
12422 ** Rmail changes.
12423
12424 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
12425 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
12426 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
12427 each time you run it.
12428
12429 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
12430 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
12431
12432 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
12433 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
12434 means to move in the opposite direction.
12435
12436 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
12437 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
12438
12439 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
12440 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
12441 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
12442 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
12443 for output.
12444
12445 ** Gnus changes.
12446
12447 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
12448
12449 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
12450 Gnus.
12451
12452 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
12453 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
12454
12455 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
12456 article mode line.
12457
12458 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
12459
12460 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
12461
12462 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
12463
12464 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
12465 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
12466 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
12467
12468 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
12469
12470 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
12471
12472 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
12473 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
12474
12475 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
12476 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
12477 used to pick articles.
12478
12479 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12480 another have been added.
12481
12482 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12483
12484 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12485 generating lines in buffers.
12486
12487 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12488 `C-M-_'.
12489
12490 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12491
12492 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12493
12494 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12495
12496 *** Scores can be decayed.
12497
12498 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12499
12500 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12501 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12502
12503 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12504 the native server.
12505
12506 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12507
12508 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12509 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12510
12511 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12512
12513 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12514 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12515
12516 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12517 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12518
12519 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12520 a group.
12521
12522 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12523 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12524
12525 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12526
12527 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12528
12529 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12530
12531 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12532
12533 Use the `Y c' command.
12534
12535 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12536
12537 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12538
12539 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12540
12541 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12542 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12543
12544 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12545
12546 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12547
12548 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12549 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12550
12551 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12552
12553 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12554 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12555 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12556 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12557 this issue.)
12558
12559 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12560 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12561 particular news group. This can be done by:
12562
12563 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12564
12565 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12566 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12567 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12568 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12569 for reading and posting).
12570
12571 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12572 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12573 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12574 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12575 there.
12576
12577 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12578 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12579
12580 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12581 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12582 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12583 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12584 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12585
12586 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12587 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12588
12589 ** CC mode changes.
12590
12591 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12592 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12593 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12594 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12595 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12596 loaded.
12597
12598 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12599 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12600 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12601 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12602 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12603 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12604
12605 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12606 of the current buffer.
12607
12608 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12609 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12610 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12611
12612 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12613 style that the Python developers like.
12614
12615 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12616 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12617 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12618
12619 ** VC Changes [new]
12620
12621 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12622 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12623 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12624
12625 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12626 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12627 developers.
12628
12629 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12630 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12631
12632 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12633 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12634 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12635 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12636
12637 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12638 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12639
12640 ** Calendar changes.
12641
12642 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12643 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12644 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12645 following/previous years.
12646
12647 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12648 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12649 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12650 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12651 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12652 supposed attribute of God.
12653
12654 ** ps-print changes
12655
12656 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12657 layout.
12658
12659 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12660
12661 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12662 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12663 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12664 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12665
12666 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12667 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12668 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12669
12670 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12671 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12672
12673 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12674 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12675 printing for your printer.
12676
12677 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12678 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12679
12680 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12681 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12682
12683 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12684 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12685 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12686 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12687 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12688 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12689 The default value is nil.
12690
12691 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12692 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12693
12694 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12695 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12696 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12697 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12698 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12699 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12700 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12701
12702 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12703 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12704
12705 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12706 The default is 0 ("black").
12707
12708 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12709 The default is 0 ("black").
12710
12711 border-width Specify the border width.
12712 The default is 0.4.
12713
12714 Any other property is ignored.
12715
12716 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12717 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12718 documentation).
12719
12720 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12721 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12722 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12723 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12724 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12725 controlling headers.
12726
12727 *** Color management (subgroup)
12728
12729 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12730 color.
12731
12732 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12733
12734 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12735 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12736 background should be used. Valid values are:
12737
12738 t always use face background color.
12739 nil never use face background color.
12740 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12741
12742 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12743
12744 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12745 sheet of paper.
12746
12747 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12748 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12749
12750 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12751 each page.
12752
12753 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12754 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12755 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12756
12757 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12758 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12759 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12760
12761 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12762 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12763 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12764
12765 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12766 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12767 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12768
12769 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12770 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12771 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12772
12773 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12774
12775 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12776
12777 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12778 RGB color.
12779
12780 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12781 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12782 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12783
12784 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12785 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12786 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12787 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12788 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12789 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12790 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12791 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12792 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12793 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12794 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12795 10 + 10 +
12796 11 + 11 +
12797 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12798 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12799 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12800 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12801 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12802 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12803 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12804 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12805 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12806 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12807 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12808 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12809 22 + 22 +
12810 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12811
12812 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12813
12814
12815 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12816
12817 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12818 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12819 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12820 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12821 to "-P".
12822
12823 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12824 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12825 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12826
12827 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12828 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12829 do so.
12830
12831 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12832
12833 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12834 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12835 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12836 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12837 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12838 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12839 `setpagedevice'.
12840
12841 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12842 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12843 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12844
12845 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12846 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12847 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12848 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12849 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12850 its TO, are ignored.
12851
12852 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12853 pages. Valid values are:
12854
12855 nil print all pages.
12856
12857 `even-page' print only even pages.
12858
12859 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12860
12861 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12862 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12863 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12864 print only the even sheet of paper.
12865
12866 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12867 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12868 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12869 only the odd sheet of paper.
12870
12871 Any other value is treated as nil.
12872
12873 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12874 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12875 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12876
12877 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12878
12879 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12880 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12881
12882 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12883 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12884 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12885 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12886 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12887 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12888 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12889
12890 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12891 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12892 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12893 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12894 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12895 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12896 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12897
12898 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12899
12900 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12901 messages should be sent.
12902
12903 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12904 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12905 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12906
12907 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12908
12909 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12910 points for line numbers.
12911
12912 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12913 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12914
12915 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12916 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12917 to 2, the printing will look like:
12918
12919 1 one line
12920 one line
12921 3 one line
12922 one line
12923 5 one line
12924 one line
12925 ...
12926
12927 Valid values are:
12928
12929 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12930 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12931 is used.
12932
12933 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12934 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12935
12936 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12937
12938 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12939 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12940 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12941 3, the output will look like:
12942
12943 one line
12944 one line
12945 3 one line
12946 one line
12947 one line
12948 6 one line
12949 one line
12950 one line
12951 9 one line
12952 one line
12953 ...
12954
12955 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12956 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12957
12958 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12959 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12960 `ps-font-size').
12961
12962 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12963 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12964 `ps-font-size').
12965
12966 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12967
12968 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12969 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12970
12971 ** hideshow changes.
12972
12973 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12974 C++, ; for lisp).
12975
12976 *** Support for java-mode added.
12977
12978 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12979 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12980
12981 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12982 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12983 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12984
12985 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12986 robust and a lot faster.
12987
12988 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12989
12990 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12991 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12992 documentation for more details.
12993
12994 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
12995
12996 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12997 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12998 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12999 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13000 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13001
13002 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13003 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13004 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13005 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13006
13007 ** Font Lock mode
13008
13009 *** Custom support
13010
13011 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13012 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
13013 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
13014 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
13015 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13016 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13017
13018 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13019
13020 *** Maximum decoration
13021
13022 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13023 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13024 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13025 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13026 to get the old behavior.
13027
13028 *** New support
13029
13030 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13031
13032 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13033 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13034
13035 *** Configurable support
13036
13037 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13038 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13039 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13040 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13041 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13042 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13043 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13044
13045 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13046 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13047 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13048
13049 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13050
13051 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13052 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13053 for any mode.
13054
13055 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13056
13057 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13058
13059 in your ~/.emacs.
13060
13061 *** New faces
13062
13063 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13064 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13065 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13066 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13067
13068 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13069
13070 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13071 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13072 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13073
13074 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13075
13076 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13077 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13078 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13079 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13080 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13081 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13082 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13083
13084 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13085 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13086 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13087 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13088 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13089 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13090
13091 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13092
13093 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13094 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13095 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13096 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13097
13098 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13099 settings.
13100
13101 ** Ada mode changes.
13102
13103 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13104 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13105 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13106 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13107 stubs.
13108
13109 *** There are two new commands:
13110 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13111 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13112
13113 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13114 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13115 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13116
13117 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13118 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13119 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13120
13121 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13122 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13123 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13124 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13125
13126 ** Scheme mode changes.
13127
13128 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13129 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13130 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13131 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13132 have any effect.
13133
13134 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13135 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13136 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13137 variables as buffer-local variables.
13138
13139 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13140 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13141
13142 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13143
13144 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13145 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13146 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13147 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13148
13149 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13150 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13151 buffer in Emacs.
13152
13153 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13154 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13155 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13156 option takes precedence.
13157
13158 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13159 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13160 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13161
13162 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13163 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13164 the current defun.
13165
13166 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13167 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13168
13169 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13170 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13171 necessary).
13172
13173 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13174 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13175 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13176 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13177 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13178 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13179
13180 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13181 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13182 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13183 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13184
13185 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13186 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13187 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13188 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13189 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13190
13191 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13192 since it applies only to the current frame.
13193
13194 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13195 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13196 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13197
13198 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13199 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13200 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13201 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13202 instead of just the file you are editing.
13203
13204 ** RefTeX mode
13205
13206 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13207 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13208 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13209 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13210 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13211
13212 C-c ( reftex-label
13213 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13214 knows which kind of label is needed.
13215
13216 C-c ) reftex-reference
13217 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13218 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13219
13220 C-c [ reftex-citation
13221 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13222 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13223
13224 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13225 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13226
13227 C-c = reftex-toc
13228 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13229 can quickly jump to every section.
13230
13231 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13232 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13233 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13234 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13235 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13236
13237 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13238
13239 *** Info documentation is now available.
13240
13241 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13242 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13243
13244 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13245 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13246
13247 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13248 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13249
13250 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13251 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13252 appropriate functions.
13253
13254 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13255 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13256
13257 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13258 been cleaned.
13259
13260 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13261 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13262
13263 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13264 shall be delimited.
13265
13266 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13267 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13268 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13269
13270 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13271 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13272 prefixed with `ALT'.
13273
13274 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13275 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13276 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13277 documentation).
13278
13279 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13280 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13281 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13282
13283 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13284 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13285
13286 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13287 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13288 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13289
13290 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13291
13292 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13293
13294 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13295 from alien sources.
13296
13297 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13298 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13299 crossref entries.
13300
13301 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13302 region.
13303
13304 *** Added support for imenu.
13305
13306 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13307 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13308 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13309 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13310
13311 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13312 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13313
13314 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13315
13316 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13317
13318 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13319 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13320 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13321 as an argument.
13322
13323 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13324 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13325
13326 ** browse-url changes
13327
13328 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13329 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13330 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13331 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13332 customization variables.
13333
13334 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13335
13336 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13337 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13338 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13339
13340 ** Changes in Ediff
13341
13342 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13343 pops up the Info file for this command.
13344
13345 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13346 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13347 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13348 directories).
13349
13350 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13351 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13352 files in the same directory.
13353
13354 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13355 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13356 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13357
13358 ** Changes in Viper
13359
13360 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13361 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13362 instead of vip-.
13363 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13364 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13365 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13366 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13367 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13368 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13369 color when Viper is in insert state.
13370 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13371 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13372 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13373
13374 ** Etags changes.
13375
13376 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13377 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13378 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13379 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13380 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13381
13382 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13383
13384 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
13385 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
13386
13387 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
13388 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
13389 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
13390
13391 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
13392 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
13393 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
13394 methods and protocols.
13395
13396 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
13397 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
13398 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
13399 paragraph name.
13400
13401 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
13402 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
13403 at least M times and as many as N times.
13404
13405 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
13406 in files has changed slightly.
13407
13408 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
13409 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
13410 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
13411 with old time-stamp-format values.
13412
13413 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
13414 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
13415 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
13416 reasons.
13417
13418 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
13419 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
13420 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
13421 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
13422 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
13423 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
13424
13425 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
13426 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
13427 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
13428
13429 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
13430 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
13431 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
13432 recommended now will continue to work then.
13433
13434 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
13435 details.
13436
13437 ** There are some additional major modes:
13438
13439 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
13440 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
13441 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
13442
13443 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
13444 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
13445 into Emacs.
13446
13447 ** New Lisp packages include:
13448
13449 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
13450
13451 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
13452 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
13453
13454 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
13455
13456 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
13457 in shell buffers.
13458
13459 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
13460 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
13461 and `elint-defun'.
13462
13463 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
13464 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
13465 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
13466 strings or comments.
13467
13468 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
13469 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
13470 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
13471 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
13472 at these points.
13473
13474 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
13475 can visit them by short forms of their names.
13476
13477 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
13478 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13479
13480 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13481
13482 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13483 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13484
13485 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13486
13487 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13488
13489 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13490
13491 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13492 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13493
13494 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13495 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13496 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13497 original place after inserting the copy.
13498
13499 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13500 on the buffer.
13501
13502 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13503 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13504 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13505
13506 Enable mouse-drag with:
13507 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13508 -or-
13509 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13510
13511 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13512 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13513
13514 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13515 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13516
13517 *** ogonek
13518
13519 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13520 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13521 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13522 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13523 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13524 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13525 instance) and vice versa.
13526
13527 To use this package load it using
13528 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13529 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13530 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13531 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13532 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13533 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13534
13535 *** Interface to ph.
13536
13537 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13538
13539 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13540 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13541 these servers.
13542
13543 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13544
13545 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13546 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13547 while the real cursor does not move.
13548
13549 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13550 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13551
13552 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13553 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13554
13555 ** movemail change
13556
13557 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13558 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13559 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13560 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13561
13562 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13563 \f
13564 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13565
13566 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13567
13568 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13569 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13570 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13571 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13572 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13573
13574 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13575 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13576 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13577 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13578 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13579 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13580 \f
13581 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13582
13583 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13584 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13585 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13586 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13587
13588 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13589 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13590
13591 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13592 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13593 "win".
13594
13595 ** Basic Lisp changes
13596
13597 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13598 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13599
13600 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13601 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13602 or by the user.
13603
13604 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13605
13606 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13607
13608 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13609 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13610
13611 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13612 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13613 its argument.
13614
13615 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13616
13617 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13618
13619 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13620
13621 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13622 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13623 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13624 `format' function.
13625
13626 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13627 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13628 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13629
13630 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13631 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13632 adding one of these suffixes.
13633
13634 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13635 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13636 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13637
13638 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13639 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13640
13641 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13642
13643 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13644 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13645
13646 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13647 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13648
13649 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13650
13651 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13652 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13653
13654 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13655 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13656 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13657 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13658
13659 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13660 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13661 of the last form.
13662
13663 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13664 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13665 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13666 as the last form.
13667
13668 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13669 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13670 matches.
13671
13672 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13673
13674 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13675 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13676 Then it returns that string.
13677
13678 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13679
13680 (with-output-to-string
13681 (princ "The buffer is ")
13682 (princ (buffer-name)))
13683
13684 returns "The buffer is foo".
13685
13686 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13687 is non-nil.
13688
13689 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13690 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13691 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13692
13693 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13694 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13695
13696 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13697 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13698 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13699 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13700 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13701 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13702
13703 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13704 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13705 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13706 characters".
13707
13708 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13709 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13710 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13711 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13712 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13713
13714 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13715 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13716 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13717 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13718
13719 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13720 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13721
13722 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13723
13724 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13725 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13726 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13727 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13728 guaranteed.
13729
13730 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13731 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13732 character).
13733
13734 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13735
13736 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13737 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13738 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13739 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13740 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13741
13742 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13743
13744 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13745 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13746 more than the number of characters.
13747
13748 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13749 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13750 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13751 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13752 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13753 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13754
13755 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13756 and returns a string containing those characters.
13757
13758 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13759 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13760 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13761 character, sref signals an error.
13762
13763 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13764 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13765 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13766
13767 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13768 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13769 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13770
13771 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13772 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13773 to a vector of the characters in it.
13774
13775 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13776 of a string. You call it as follows:
13777
13778 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13779
13780 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13781 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13782 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13783 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13784 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13785
13786 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13787 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13788
13789 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13790 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13791
13792 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13793 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13794 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13795 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13796
13797 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13798
13799 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13800
13801 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13802 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13803 are not included in the resulting value.
13804
13805 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13806 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13807 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13808 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13809
13810 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13811 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13812 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13813 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13814 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13815 column START-COLUMN.
13816
13817 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13818 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13819 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13820 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13821 changed text, before the change.
13822
13823 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13824 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13825 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13826
13827 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13828
13829 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13830
13831 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13832 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13833
13834 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13835 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13836 which identify the character within that character set.
13837
13838 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13839 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13840 opposite of split-char.
13841
13842 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13843 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13844
13845 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13846 of all the characters in a string.
13847
13848 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13849 and specifying coding systems.
13850
13851 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13852 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13853 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13854 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13855 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13856 as what to do about code conversion.)
13857
13858 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13859 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13860
13861 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13862 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13863 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13864
13865 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13866 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13867 to match against a file name.
13868
13869 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13870 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13871 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13872 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13873 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13874 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13875
13876 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13877 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13878
13879 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13880 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13881
13882 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13883 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13884 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13885 service names.
13886
13887 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13888 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13889 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13890 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13891 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13892 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13893
13894 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13895 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13896
13897 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13898 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13899 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13900 start the subprocess.
13901
13902 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13903 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13904 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13905 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13906 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13907
13908 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13909 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13910 subprocess.
13911
13912 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13913 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13914 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13915 connection permanently or until overridden.
13916
13917 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13918 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13919 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13920 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13921 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13922 system for one operation at a time.
13923
13924 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13925 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13926
13927 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13928 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13929 The value is a cons cell,
13930 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13931 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13932 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13933 input to the subprocess.
13934
13935 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13936 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13937
13938 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13939 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13940 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13941
13942 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13943 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13944 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13945 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13946 customization.
13947
13948 Thus, instead of writing
13949
13950 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13951 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13952
13953 you would now write this:
13954
13955 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13956 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13957 :type 'boolean
13958 :group foo)
13959
13960 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13961 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13962 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13963 for a description of them.
13964
13965 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13966 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13967
13968 (defgroup ispell nil
13969 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13970 :group 'processes)
13971
13972 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13973 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13974 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13975 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13976 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13977
13978 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13979 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13980 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13981 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13982 first-level subgroups.
13983
13984 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13985
13986 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13987 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13988
13989 ** easy-mmode
13990
13991 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13992 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13993 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13994 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13995 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13996 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13997
13998 ** Text property changes
13999
14000 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14001 text property.
14002
14003 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14004 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14005 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14006 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14007 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14008
14009 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14010 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14011 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14012 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14013
14014 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14015 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14016 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14017
14018 ** Changes in invisibility features
14019
14020 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14021 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14022 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14023 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14024 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14025 make the overlay visible.
14026
14027 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14028 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14029 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14030 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14031 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14032 t when it should hide it.
14033
14034 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14035
14036 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14037 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14038 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14039 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14040 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14041 Here is an example of how to do this:
14042
14043 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14044 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14045 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14046 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14047
14048 ...
14049 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14050
14051 ...
14052 ;; When done with the overlays:
14053 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14054 ;; Or respectively:
14055 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14056
14057 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14058
14059 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14060 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14061 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14062 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14063
14064 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14065 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14066 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14067
14068 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14069 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14070
14071 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14072 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14073
14074 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14075 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14076 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14077
14078 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14079 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14080 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14081 determine the syntax type of the character.
14082
14083 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14084 of the current buffer.
14085
14086 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14087 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14088 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14089
14090 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14091 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14092 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14093 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14094 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14095
14096 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14097 text property.
14098
14099 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14100 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14101 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14102
14103 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14104 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14105 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14106 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14107 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14108
14109 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14110 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14111 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14112
14113 ** Changes in face features
14114
14115 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14116 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14117
14118 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14119 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14120
14121 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14122 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14123
14124 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14125 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14126
14127 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14128 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14129 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14130 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14131 overlay property).
14132
14133 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14134 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14135
14136 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14137
14138 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14139 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14140 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14141 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14142
14143 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14144 begins with ~.
14145
14146 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14147 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14148
14149 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14150 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14151
14152 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14153 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14154
14155 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14156 character code conversion as well as other things.
14157
14158 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14159 (formerly it did not).
14160
14161 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14162 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14163
14164 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14165 instead of constant strings.
14166
14167 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14168 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14169 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14170
14171 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14172 in the same way as before.
14173
14174 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14175 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14176 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14177
14178 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14179 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14180 else, and returns nil.
14181
14182 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14183 directory cannot be listed.
14184
14185 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14186
14187 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14188 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14189 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14190 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14191 ways:
14192
14193 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14194 It is available through the history command M-n.
14195
14196 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14197 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14198 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14199 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14200 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14201
14202 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14203 argument in this way.
14204
14205 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14206 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14207 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14208
14209 ** Echo area features
14210
14211 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14212 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14213 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14214 after the echo area is cleared.
14215
14216 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14217 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14218
14219 ** Keyboard input features
14220
14221 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14222 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14223
14224 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14225 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14226 by keyboard macros.
14227
14228 ** Frame-related changes
14229
14230 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14231 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14232 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14233
14234 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14235 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14236 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14237
14238 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14239 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14240 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14241 in the selected frame.
14242
14243 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14244 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14245 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14246
14247 ** X Windows features
14248
14249 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14250 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14251 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14252
14253 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14254 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14255
14256 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14257 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14258 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14259
14260 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14261 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14262
14263 ** Subprocess features
14264
14265 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14266 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14267 automatically.
14268
14269 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14270 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14271
14272 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14273 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14274
14275 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14276 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14277
14278 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14279 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14280 goes after the other menu items.
14281
14282 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14283 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14284 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14285 are in use.
14286
14287 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14288 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14289
14290 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14291 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14292 form.
14293
14294 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14295 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14296 but its hook is still run.
14297
14298 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14299 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14300
14301 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14302 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14303 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14304
14305 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14306 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14307 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14308 warned.
14309
14310 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14311 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14312
14313 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14314 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14315 functions like display-time.
14316
14317 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14318 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14319
14320 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14321 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14322 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14323
14324 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14325 if there is an error in compilation.
14326
14327 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14328 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14329 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14330 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14331
14332 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14333 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14334 the *scratch* buffer.
14335
14336 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14337 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14338 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14339 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14340
14341 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14342 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14343 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14344
14345 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14346 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14347 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14348 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14349
14350 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14351 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14352 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14353
14354 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14355 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14356 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14357 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14358 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14359 files at all.
14360
14361 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14362 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14363 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14364 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14365
14366 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14367 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14368 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14369 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14370
14371 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14372
14373 ** imenu.el changes.
14374
14375 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14376 item from menu created by imenu.
14377
14378 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14379 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14380 select one of those items.
14381 \f
14382 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14383
14384 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
14385 Copyright information:
14386
14387 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
14388
14389 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
14390 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
14391 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
14392 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
14393
14394 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
14395 of this document, or of portions of it,
14396 under the above conditions, provided also that they
14397 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
14398 \f
14399 Local variables:
14400 mode: outline
14401 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
14402 end:
14403
14404 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793